Insolvency Law and Practice
Insolvency Law and Practice
Insolvency Law and Practice
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
INSOLVENCY –
LAW AND PRACTICE
MODULE 3
ELECTIVE PAPER 9.8
i
© THE INSTITUTE OF COMPANY SECRETARIES OF INDIA
TIMING OF HEADQUARTERS
Monday to Friday
Office Timings – 9.00 A.M. to 5.30 P.M.
Phone
011-45341000
Fax
011-24626727
Website
www.icsi.edu
E-mail
info@icsi.edu
ii
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
Module 3
Elective Paper 9.8
Insolvency – Law and Practice
(Max Marks 100)
Objective
To acquire expert knowledge of the legal, procedural and practical aspects of Insolvency and its resolution.
Detailed Contents
1. Insolvency – Concepts and Evolution: Bankruptcy/Insolvency– the Concept; Historical Developments
of Insolvency Laws in India; A Brief on Historical Background on UK Insolvency Framework; US
Bankruptcy Laws.
2. Introduction to Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code: Historical Background; Report of the Bankruptcy
Law Reforms Committee, Need for the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016; Overall scheme of the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code; Important Definitions; Institutions under Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code, 2016.
3. Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process: Legal Provisions; Committee of Creditors; Procedure;
Documentation; Appearance; Approval.
4. Insolvency Resolution of Corporate Persons: Contents of resolution plan; Submission of resolution
plan; Approval of resolution plan.
5. Resolution Strategies: Restructuring of Equity and Debt; Compromise and Arrangement; Acquisition;
Takeover and Change of Management; Sale of Assets.
6. Fast Track Corporation Insolvency Resolution Process: Applicability for fast track process; Time
period for completion of fast track process; Procedure for fast track process.
7. Liquidation of Corporate Person: Initiation of Liquidation; Powers and duties of Liquidator; Liquidation
Estate; Distribution of assets; Dissolution of corporate debtor.
8. Voluntary Liquidation of Companies: Procedure for Voluntary Liquidation; Initiation of Liquidation;
Effect of liquidation; Appointment; remuneration; powers and duties of Liquidator; Completion of
Liquidation.
9. Adjudication and Appeals for Corporate Persons: Adjudicating Authority in relation to insolvency
resolution and liquidation for corporate persons; Jurisdiction of NCLT; Grounds for appeal against order
of liquidation; Appeal to Supreme Court on question of law; Penalty of carrying on business fraudulently
to defraud traders.
10. Debt Recovery and Securitization: Non-performing assets; Asset Reconstruction Companies [ARC];
Security Interest (Enforcement) Rules, 2002; Options available with banks e.g. SARFAESI, DRT, etc.,
Application to the Tribunal/Appellate Tribunal.
iii
11. Winding-Up by Tribunal: Introduction; Is winding up and dissolution are synonymous? Winding up
under the Companies Act, 2013; Powers of the Tribunal; Fraudulent preferences.
12. Cross Border Insolvency : Introduction; Global developments; UNCITRAL Legislative Guide on
Insolvency Laws; UNCITRAL Model Law on Cross Border Insolvency; US Bankruptcy Code; World
Bank Principles for Effective Insolvency and Creditor Rights; ADB principles of Corporate Rescue and
Rehabilitation; Enabling provisions for cross border transactions under IBC, Agreements with foreign
countries.
13. Insolvency Resolution of Individual and Partnership Firms: Application for insolvency resolution
process; Procedural aspects; Discharge order.
14. Bankruptcy Order for Individuals and Partnership firms: Bankruptcy if insolvency resolution process
fails; Application for bankruptcy; Conduct of meeting of creditors; Discharge order; Effect of discharge
order.
15. Bankruptcy for Individuals and Partnership Firms: Background; Overview of the provisions;
Adjudicating Authority; Appeal against order of DRT; Appeal to Supreme Court.
16. Fresh Start Process: Background; Application for fresh start order; Procedure after receipt of
application; Discharge order.
17. Professional and Ethical Practices for Insolvency Practitioners: Responsibility and accountability
of Insolvency Practitioners; Code of conduct; Case laws; Case Studies; and Practical aspects.
iv
LESSON WISE SUMMARY
INSOLVENCY – LAW AND PRACTICE
v
Lesson 4 – Insolvency Resolution of Corporate Persons
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 marks a substantial change in legislative policy relating to corporate
insolvency, wherein, creditors in general and financial creditors in particular are substantially empowered to
obtain debts due to them.
With regard to corporate insolvency, the Code adopts an applicant-based approach, providing for different
mechanisms for insolvency resolution for financial creditors, operational creditors and corporate applicants.
In corporate insolvency resolution process, the financial creditors assess the viability of debtor’s business and
the options for its revival and rehabilitation. If the corporate insolvency resolution process fails or the financial
creditors decide that the business of the debtor cannot be carried on in a profitable manner and it should be
wound up, the debtor’s business undergoes the liquidation process.
vii
are paid off and the surplus, if any, distributed among its members. Dissolution is the final stage whereby the
existence of the company is withdrawn by the law. Dissolution brings about an end to the legal entity of the
company. The main purpose of winding up of a company is to realize the assets and pay the company’s debts
expeditiously and fairly in accordance with the law. If any surplus is left, it is distributed among the members in
accordance with their rights.
viii
two Acts in India: the Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909 (for the erstwhile Presidency towns, i.e. Kolkata,
Mumbai and Chennai) and the Provincial Insolvency Act, 1920 (for the rest of India). Though these are central
laws, it should be noted that both these Acts have a number of state specific amendments. The substantive
provisions under the two Acts are largely similar. There have not been any substantial changes to this regime
over the years and it has proved to be largely ineffective in practice.
In 2016, Parliament enacted Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code. The law aims to consolidate the laws relating to
insolvency of companies and limited liability entities (including limited liability partnerships and other entities with
limited liability), unlimited liability partnerships and individuals, presently contained in a number of legislations,
into a single legislation.
ix
ARRANGEMENT OF STUDY LESSONS
x
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
CONTENTS
LESSON 1
INSOLVENCY – CONCEPTS AND EVOLUTION
LESSON 2
INTRODUCTION TO INSOLVENCY AND BANKRUPTCY CODE
Introduction 25
Historical Developments of Insolvency Laws in India 25
Need for a New Law 27
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 – Introduction 28
Key Objectives of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 29
How Code is Organised 29
Part I Preliminary 29
Part II Insolvency Resolution and Liquidation for Corporate Persons 29
xi
Part III Insolvency Resolution and Bankruptcy for Individuals and Partnership Firms 29
Part IV Regulation of Insolvency Professionals, Agencies and Information Utilities 30
Part V Miscellaneous 30
Salient Features of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 30
Pillars of Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 33
(A) Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India (IBBI) 33
(B) Insolvency Professionals (IPs) 36
(C) Insolvency Professional Agencies (IPA) 37
(D) Adjudicating Authority (AA) 38
(E) Information Utility (IU) 39
Key Definitions and Concepts 40
Definitions in Section 3 of the Code 40
Definitions in Section 5 of the Code 43
Definitions in Section 79 of the Code 47
LESSON 3
CORPORATE INSOLVENCY RESOLUTION PROCESS
Introduction 51
Persons who may Initiate Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 51
Initiation of Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process by Financial Creditor 53
Insolvency Resolution by Operational Creditor 55
Application for Initiation of Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process by Operational Creditor 56
Persons Not Entitled to Make Application 60
Time-limit for Completion of Insolvency Resolution Process 61
Withdrawal of Application Admitted under Section 7, 9 or 10 62
Committee of Creditors 62
Committee with only operational creditors 68
Meeting of Committee of Creditors 69
Rights and Duties of Authorised Representative of Financial Creditors 70
Approval of Committee of Creditors for Certain Actions 70
LESSON 4
INSOLVENCY RESOLUTION OF CORPORATE PERSONS
LESSON 5
RESOLUTION STRATEGIES
Introduction 79
Debt restructuring 80
Formal Restructuring And Insolvency Proceedings 80
Equity Restructuring 82
Compromises, Arrangements and Amalgamations 82
Power to Compromise or make Arrangements 82
Power of Tribunal to enforce compromise or arrangement 86
Merger and amalgamation of companies 87
Merger or amalgamation of certain companies 89
Merger or amalgamation of company with foreign company 91
Power to acquire shares of shareholders dissenting from scheme or contract approved by majority 91
Purchase of minority shareholding 93
Power of Central Government to provide for amalgamation of companies in public interest 94
Registration of offer of schemes involving transfer of shares 95
Preservation of books and papers of amalgamated companies 95
Liability of officers in respect of offences committed prior to merger, amalgamation 96
Sale of Assets under Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code 96
Sale of Assets 96
Mode of sale 96
Asset memorandum 97
Valuation of assets intended to be sold 97
Asset sale report 98
Realization of security interest by secured creditor 98
Distribution of unsold assets 99
Recovery of monies due 99
Liquidator to realize uncalled capital or unpaid capital contribution 99
xiii
LESSON 6
FAST TRACK CORPORATION INSOLVENCY RESOLUTION PROCESS
Introduction 101
Fast track corporation insolvency resolution process 101
Time period for completion of fast track corporate insolvency resolution process 101
Manner of initiating fast track corporate insolvency resolution process 102
Fast Track Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate Persons Regulations, 2017 102
Important Definitions 102
Access to Books 104
Extortionate Credit Transaction 104
Public Announcement 104
Claims by Operational Creditors 104
Claims by Financial Creditors 105
Claims by Workmen and Employees 105
Claims by Other Creditors 106
Substantiation of Claims 106
Cost of Proof proving the Debt 106
Submission of Proof of Claims 106
Verification of Claims 106
Determination of amount of Claim 107
Debt in Foreign Currency 107
Committee with only Operational Creditors 107
Filings by the Interim Resolution Professional 107
Meetings of the Committee 108
Notice for Meetings of the Committee 108
Service of Notice by Electronic Means 108
Contents of the Notice for Meeting 109
Quorum at the Meeting 109
Participation Through Video Conferencing 109
Conduct of Meeting 110
Voting by the Committee 111
Appointment of Registered Valuer 111
Transfer of Debt due to Creditors 112
xiv
Sale of Assets Outside the Ordinary Course of Business 112
Assistance of Local District Administration 112
Fast Track Process Costs 112
Essential Supplies 113
Costs of the Interim Resolution Professional 113
Resolution Professional Costs 113
Fair Value and Liquidation Value 113
Information Memorandum 114
Invitation of Resolution Plans 115
Resolution Plan 115
Mandatory Contents of the Resolution Plan 116
Approval of Resolution Plan 117
Extension of the Fast Track Process Period 117
LESSON 7
LIQUIDATION OF CORPORATE PERSON
xv
Orders of Adjudicating Authority in Respect of Extortionate Credit Transactions 131
Secured Creditor in Liquidation Proceedings 131
Distribution of Assets 132
Dissolution of Corporate Debtor 134
LESSON 8
VOLUNTARY LIQUIDATION OF COMPANIES
LESSON 9
ADJUDICATION AND APPEALS FOR CORPORATE PERSONS
Introduction 143
Adjudicating Authority for Corporate Persons 143
Appeals and Appellate Authority 144
Appeal to Supreme Court 145
NCLT Benches & their jurisdiction 146
Civil court not to have jurisdiction 147
Expeditious disposal of applications 147
Fraudulent or malicious initiation of proceedings 147
Case Law 147
Fraudulent trading or wrongful trading 147
Proceeding under Section 66 148
LESSON 10
DEBT RECOVERY & SECURITIZATION
Introduction 149
How Securitisation gained importance? 149
Statement of objects and reasons of SARFAESI Act 150
Apex Court Upheld Constitutional Validity of the Securitisation Act 151
Definitions 152
Asset Reconstruction Companies [ARC] 156
Regulation of Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets of Banks and Financial Institutions 156
xvi
Cancellation of Certificate of Registration 157
Acquisition of rights or interest in financial assets 158
Transfer of pending applications to any one of Debts Recovery Tribunals in certain cases 159
Notice to obligor and discharge of obligation of such obligor 160
Issue of security by raising of receipts or funds by Asset Reconstruction Company 160
Exemption from registration of security receipt 161
Measures for Asset reconstruction 161
Other functions of asset reconstruction company 161
Resolution of disputes 162
Power of Reserve Bank to determine policy and issue directions 162
Section 12A deals with the power of Reserve Bank to call for statements and information. 162
Section 12B deals with the power of Reserve Bank to carry out audit and inspection. 163
Enforcement of Security interest by a Creditors 163
Assistance by Chief Metropolitan Magistrate or the District Magistrate 166
Manner and effect of takeover of Management 167
No compensation to directors for loss of office 168
Application against measures to recover secured debts 168
Appeal to Appellate Tribunal 170
Right to lodge a caveat 170
Right of borrower to receive compensation and costs in certain cases 171
Setting up of Central Registry 171
Integration of registration systems with Central Registry 172
Delegation of powers 172
Central Registrar 172
Register of Securitisation, reconstruction and security interest transactions 172
Filing of transactions of securitisation, reconstruction and creation of security interest 173
Modification of security interest registered under this Act. 173
Satisfaction of Security interest 173
Right to Inspect 174
Rectification by Central Government in matters of registration, modification and satisfaction 174
Registration by secured creditors and other creditors 174
Effect of the registration of transactions 175
Right of Enforcement of Securities 175
Penalties 175
xvii
Penalties for non-compliance of direction of Reserve Bank 176
Offences 176
Non-Applicability in certain cases 176
Civil Court not to have jurisdiction 176
Limitation Act 177
Applicability of other Acts 177
Security Interest (Enforcement) Rules, 2002 177
Demand notice 177
Reply to Representation of the borrower 177
Procedure after issue of notice 178
Valuation of movable secured assets 179
Sale of movable secured assets 179
Issue of certificate of sale 180
Sale of immovable secured assets 180
Time of sale, issue of sale certificate and delivery of possession, etc. 181
Appointment of Manager 182
Procedure for recovery of shortfall of secured debt 182
Application to the Tribunal/Appellate Tribunal 183
Debt Recovery 183
Need and Object 183
Important Definitions 184
Establishment of Tribunal 185
Composition of Tribunal 186
Establishment of Appellate Tribunal 186
Composition of Appellate Tribunal, Qualifications and its Term 187
Jurisdiction, Powers and Authority of Tribunals 187
Power of Chairperson of Appellate Tribunal 188
Bar of Jurisdiction 188
Application to the tribunal 188
Appeal to the appellate tribunal 194
Procedure and powers of the tribunal and the appellate tribunal 195
Right to legal representation and presenting officers 195
Limitations 195
Recovery of Debt Determined By Tribunal 195
xviii
Validity of certificate and amendment thereof 196
Stay of proceedings under certificate and amendment or withdrawal thereof 196
Other modes of recovery 197
Application of certain provisions of income-tax act 198
Appeal against the order of recovery officer 198
Deposit of amount of debt due for filing appeal against orders of the Recovery Officer 198
Transfer of pending cases 198
Power of tribunal to issue certificate of recovery in case of decree or order 199
Priority to secured creditors 199
Act to have over-riding effect 199
LESSON 11
WINDING-UP BY TRIBUNAL
Introduction 201
Important Changes brought about by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 201
LESSON 12
CROSS BORDER INSOLVENCY
Introduction 213
Key Objectives of Effective and Efficient Insolvency Law 213
The United Nations Commission on International Trade (UNCITRAL) 214
UNCITRAL Legislative Guide on Insolvency Laws 214
Organization and Scope of the Legislative Guide 215
Purpose 215
Relevance to International Trade 215
Key Provisions 216
UNCITRAL Model Law on Cross Border Insolvency 217
Purpose 217
Relevance to International Trade 217
Key Provisions 217
UNCITRAL Model Law on Cross-Border Insolvency 218
Scope of application 219
Principle of Supremacy of International Obligations 219
Competent Court or Authority 219
Interpretation 219
United States Bankruptcy Code 219
Chapter 11 Reorganization 220
Salient Features of Chapter 11 220
Enabling provisions for cross border transactions under Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 221
Insolvency Law Committee on Cross Border Insolvency 222
xx
LESSON 13
INSOLVENCY RESOLUTION OF INDIVIDUAL AND PARTNERSHIP FIRMS
Introduction 223
Moratorium 227
xxi
LESSON 14
BANKRUPTCY ORDER FOR INDIVIDUAL AND PARTNERSHIP FIRMS
Introduction 233
Application for bankruptcy 233
Application by debtor 233
Application by creditor 234
Effect of application 234
Appointment of Insolvency Professional as Bankruptcy Trustee 234
Bankruptcy Order 235
Validity of Bankruptcy Order 235
Effect of bankruptcy order 235
Statement of financial position 236
Public notice inviting claims from creditors 236
Registration of claims 236
Preparation of list of creditors 236
Summoning of meeting of creditors 236
Conduct of meeting of creditors 237
Voting rights of creditors 237
Administration and distribution of estate of bankrupt 237
Completion of administration 237
Discharge Order 238
Effect of discharge 238
Disqualification of bankrupt 238
Restrictions on bankrupt 238
Modification or recall of bankruptcy order 239
Standard of conduct 239
Fees of bankruptcy trustee 239
Replacement of bankruptcy trustee 240
Resignation by bankruptcy trustee 240
Vacancy in the office of bankruptcy trustee 240
Release of bankruptcy trustee 241
xxii
LESSON 15
BANKRUPTCY FOR INDIVIDUALS AND PARTNERSHIP FIRMS
Introduction 243
Functions of Bankruptcy Trustee 243
Duties of Bankrupt towards Bankruptcy Trustee 243
Rights of Bankruptcy Trustee 244
General Powers of Bankruptcy Trustee 244
Approval of Creditors for Certain acts 245
Vesting of Estate of Bankrupt in Bankruptcy Trustee 245
Estate of Bankrupt 245
Delivery of Property and Documents to Bankruptcy Trustee 246
Acquisition of Control by Bankruptcy Trustee 246
Restrictions on Disposition of Property 246
After-acquired Property of Bankrupt (Section 159) 246
Onerous Property of Bankrupt 247
Notice to Disclaim Onerous Property 247
Disclaimer of Leaseholds 248
Challenge Against Disclaimed Property 248
Undervalued Transactions 248
Preference Transactions 249
Effect of order 250
Extortionate credit transactions 250
Obligations under contracts 251
Continuance of proceedings on death of bankrupt 251
Administration of estate of deceased bankrupt 251
Proof of debt 252
Proof of debt by secured creditors 252
Mutual credit and set-off 252
Distribution of interim dividend 253
Distribution of property 253
Final dividend 253
Claims of creditors 254
Priority of payment of debts 254
xxiii
Adjudicating Authority for individuals and partnership firms 255
Civil court not to have jurisdiction 255
Appeal to Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunal. - 256
Appeal to Supreme Court 256
LESSON 16
FRESH START PROCESS
Introduction 257
Who can make application for fresh start process? 257
Filing of applications for fresh start process and its effect thereof 258
Appointment of Resolution Professional 258
Examination of application by Resolution Professional 259
Admission or rejection of application by Adjudicating Authority and its effect thereof 259
Objections by creditor and their examination by Resolution Professional 260
Application against decision of Resolution Professional 261
General duties of Debtor 261
Replacement of Resolution Professional 261
Directions for compliances of restrictions 261
Revocation of order admitting application 262
Discharge Order 262
Standard of Conduct 262
Fresh Start Process 263
LESSON 17
PROFESSIONAL AND ETHICAL PRACTICES FOR INSOLVENCY PRACTITIONERS
xxiv
Public Announcement of Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 272
Appointment, Tenure and Duties of Interim Resolution Professional 272
Management of Affairs of Corporate Debtor by Interim Resolution Professional 274
Duties of Interim Resolution Professional 275
Personnel to Extend Co-operation to Interim Resolution Professional 276
Management of Operations of Corporate Debtor as Going Concern 277
Appointment of Resolution Professional 278
Eligibility for Resolution Professional 279
Resolution Professional to Conduct Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 279
Duties of Resolution Professional 280
Replacement of Resolution Professional by Committee of Creditors 281
xxv
xxvi
Lesson 1
Insolvency – Concepts and Evolution
1. http://bifr.nic.in/aboutus.htm
1
2 PP-IL&P
– Nationalisation of Banks and certain other measures provided some temporary relief.
– RBI monitored the industrial sickness.
– A study group, came to be known as Tandon Committee was appointed by RBI in 1975.
– In 1976, H.N. Ray committee was appointed.
– In 1981, Tiwari Committee was appointed to suggest a comprehensive special legislation designed
to deal with the problem of sickness laying down its basic objectives and parameters, remedies
necessary for revival of sick Units.
– The committee submitted its report to the Govt. in September 1983 and suggested the following :
(a) Need for a special legislation
(b) Need for setting up of exclusive quasi-judicial body.
Thus the SICA came into existence in 1985 and BIFR started functioning from 1987.
the common law and the civil law systems, are now coming closer, common law systems adopting structure of
administrative authority including administrative justice for the management of various state functions; and the
civil law system on the other hand, incorporating the principles of accusive system and judicial process. In India,
we have under the present constitutional paradigm partially adopted tribunalised form of justice under article
323 A and 323 B20. But there are also judicial observations. It is true that in L. Chandrakumar 21, Supreme
Court finally gave its nod in favour of tribunalised system of justice. But the reservation of judiciary against
the erosion of judicial power especially at the High Court level is quite evident. It is not possible to oust the
jurisdiction of the High Court under Articles 226 and 227 without amending the provision of Article 323B.
The Advisory Group discussed in details the possibility of avoiding the dualism in the system so that the whole
process can be put into a straight line to avoid delay. In that context the following two methods have been
discussed.
• Constituting a National Tribunal with benches at the jurisdiction of each High Court to receive and deal
with all petitions for bankruptcy, restructuring and finally for insolvency with an appeal lying to the High
Court and SLP to the Supreme Court; and
• Having a completely dedicated bench in each High Court dealing with the entire matter of bankruptcy;
reorganisation( similar to reorganisation under Chapter 11 of the US code); and insolvency proceedings
ensuring fast track liquidation, the only appeal being by way of a special leave petition to the Supreme
Court.
The Timelines
• The committee brought out interim report in the month of February 2015 and the final report on
November 04, 2015.
• Ministry of Finance invited comments on Draft Insolvency and Bankruptcy Bill in November 2015 based
on the recommendation of report of Vishwanathan Committee.
• The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2015 was introduced in Lok Sabha on December 21, 2015
Lesson 1 n Insolvency – Concepts and Evolution 5
• The bill was referred to Joint committee on The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2015.
• The report of the joint committee was presented in Loksabha and laid down in Rajya sabha on April 28,
2016.
• The code was passed by Loksabha on May 05, 2016.
• The Code was passed by Rajya Sabha on May 11, 2016.
• The Code received president’s assent on May 28 2016.
The code shall come into force on such date as the Central Government may, by notification in the Official
Gazette, appoint. Different dates may be appointed for different provisions of this Code and any reference in
any such provision to the commencement of this Code shall be construed as a reference to the commencement
of that provision.
Highlights of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 in the context of corporate Insolvency
• The preamble of the code reads as under:
To consolidate and amend the laws relating to reorganisation and insolvency resolution of corporate
persons, partnership firms and individuals in a time bound manner for maximisation of value of assets
of such persons, to promote entrepreneurship, availability of credit and balance the interests of all the
stakeholders including alteration in the order of priority of payment of Government dues and to establish
an Insolvency and Bankruptcy Fund, and for matters connected therewith or incidental thereto.
• The Code proposes to cover Insolvency of individuals, unlimited liability partnerships, Limited Liability
partnerships (LLPs) and companies.
• The Insolvency Resolution Process (IRP) for individuals and unlimited liability partnerships varies from
that of companies and LLPs. The Debt Recovery Tribunal (“DRT”) shall be the Adjudicating Authority
with jurisdiction over individuals and unlimited liability partnership firms. Appeals from the order of
DRT shall lie to the Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunal (“DRAT”). The National Company Law Tribunal
(“NCLT”) shall be the Adjudicating Authority with jurisdiction over companies, limited liability entities.
Appeals from the order of NCLT shall lie to the National Company Law Appellate Tribunal (“NCLAT”).
• The Code proposes to establish an Insolvency Regulator (The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of
India) to exercise regulatory oversight over
– Insolvency Professionals,
– Insolvency Professional Agencies and
– Information Utilities.
• The Code proposes to regulate insolvency professionals and insolvency professional agencies.
Under Regulator’s oversight, these agencies will develop professional standards, codes of ethics and
exercise a disciplinary role over errant members leading to the development of a competitive industry
for insolvency professionals.
• The Code proposes for information utilities which would collect, collate, authenticate and disseminate
financial information from listed companies and financial and operational creditors of companies. An
individual insolvency database is also proposed to be set up with the goal of providing information on
insolvency status of individuals.
• The Code proposes a swift process and timeline of 180 days for dealing with applications for corporate
insolvency resolution. This can be extended for 90 days by the Adjudicating Authority only one time
extension. During insolvency resolution period (of 180/270 days), the management of the debtor is
placed in the hands of an interim resolution professional/resolution professional.
6 PP-IL&P
• Further, an insolvency resolution plan prepared by the resolution professional has to be approved by
a majority of 66% of voting share of the financial creditors. Once the plan is approved, it would require
sanction of the Adjudicating Authority. If an insolvency resolution plan is rejected, the Adjudicating
Authority will make an order for the liquidation.
• The Code proposes for a fast track insolvency resolution process for companies with smaller operations.
The process will have to be completed within 90 days, which may be extended upto 45 more days if
75% of financial creditors agree. Extension shall not be given more than once.
Framework of The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code 2016
Part II- Insolvency Part III- Insolvency
Part I - Preliminary Resolution and Resolution and
Liquidation for Bankruptcy for individuals
Corporate Persons and partnership firms
Eleven Schedules(Amendments to
different Legislations)
The framework of Part II-Insolvency Resolution and Liquidation for Corporate Persons
7. The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest
Act, 2002
8. Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Repeal Act, 2003
9. The payment and Settlement Systems Act, 2007
10. The Limited Liability Partnership Act, 2008
11. The Companies Act, 2013
Information Utilities Insolvency Professional Agencies
Insolvency Professional
The
The Insolvency
Insolvency Adjudication
Adjudication Process
Process
Debt Recovery Tribunal- National Company law Tribunal
Adjudicating Authority (NCLT) - Adjudicating Authority
Appeal to Debt Recovery Appeal to National Company
Appellate Tribunal Law Appellate Tribunal
(DRAT) (NCLAT)
Appeal to Supreme
Court
8 PP-IL&P
UK
In UK, any creditor can apply to the
court for an administration order in
relation to the company.
US
In the US, a Chapter 11 proceeding
may be commenced on the filing of
a petition under Chapter 11 by three
or more entities, each of which is
either a holder of a claim against
the company that is not contingent
as to liability or the subject of a
bona fide dispute, or an indenture
trustee representing such a holder,
if such non-contingent, undisputed
claims aggregate at least $10,000
more than the value of any lien on
property of the debtor securing
such claims held by the holders of
such claims.
3 Moratorium Section 13 NCLT can declare Many countries provide for an
and 14 and moratorium period which automatic moratorium on other
31 starts from the date of proceedings once the company
acceptance of application enters formal insolvency
by NCLT and continue till proceedings. The possibility of
approval of the resolution abuse of the moratorium by the
plan. debtor company arising in such
a case is prevented through
the incorporation of suitable
safeguards for secured creditors.
US
Section 362 of the US Bankruptcy
Code provides for an automatic
moratorium on the enforcement
of claims against the company
and its property upon the filing
of a Chapter 11 petition. The
moratorium covers judicial and
administrative proceedings,
enforcement of judgments against
the company or its estate, acts to
obtain possession/control of estate
property, acts to create, perfect or
enforce liens, acts to collect claims,
exercise of right of set off, tax
10 PP-IL&P
US
In contrast, the US follows a
debtor-in-possession regime
wherein the management
remains in control of the debtor
company even after Chapter-11
proceedings have been initiated.
It has been suggested that in the
case of a debtor-in-possession
regime as under Chapter 11 of
the US Bankruptcy Code, the
management would be encouraged
to make a timely reference for early
resolution of financial distress
as they would not fear the loss
of control in the event of entry
into insolvency proceedings.108
However, such a system has
been criticized because it leaves
the management (which may be
responsible for the company’s
failure) in charge of managing the
rescue proceedings.109 It could
also increase risks of fraudulent
activity by the management,
including the siphoning away of
the company’s assets. However,
the US bankruptcy law provides
an important safeguard against the
abuse of the debtor-in-possession
regime by permitting the
appointment of a trustee in certain
circumstances. Section 1104(a)
of the Bankruptcy Code permits
the appointment of a trustee to
take over the management of the
debtor company on two grounds.
A trustee shall be appointed
for cause, including fraud,
dishonesty, incompetence or gross
mismanagement of the debtor
company’s affairs by the present
management, either before or
after the commencement of the
Chapter 11 case, or for a similar
cause.110 It must be noted that
the grounds mentioned in Section
1104(a)(1) are not exhaustive.
Lesson 1 n Insolvency – Concepts and Evolution 15
1. Regulatory Framework in UK
The 1982 Report of the Insolvency Law review Committee, Insolvency Laws and Practice (commonly known as
“the Cork Report”) recommended the adoption in the United Kingdom of Unified Insolvency legislation. Ultimately
the Insolvency Act, 1986 (UK) was enacted and this encompasses both types of insolvency administrations,
including corporate restructuring.
The existing UK insolvency framework is defined by the Insolvency Act 1986. According to the Act, failing
companies are either liquidated or submitted to an insolvency process that may allow them to be rescued as
going concerns.
The Insolvency Act, 1986 deals the insolvency of individuals and companies. The Act is divided into three
groups and 14 Schedules as follows:
Group 1 deals with Company Insolvency
Group 2 deals with Insolvency of Individuals and
Group 3 deals with Miscellaneous Matters Bearing on both Company & Individual Insolvency
Basically, a company in financial difficulties may be made subject to any of five statutory procedures.
1. administration;
2. company voluntary arrangement;
3 scheme of arrangement;
4. receivership (including administrative receivership); and
5. liquidation (winding-up).
With the exception of schemes of arrangement, which fall within the ambit of the Companies Act, 2006, these
are formal insolvency procedures governed by the Insolvency Act, 1986.
Lesson 1 n Insolvency – Concepts and Evolution 21
The administration procedure was introduced by the insolvency Act, 1986 and substantially revised by the
Enterprise Act, 2002 to include a streamlined procedure allowing the company or (more often) its directors to
appoint an administrator without the involvement of the Court subject to conditions.
Firms are in fact liquidated if they become the subject of a compulsory liquidation order obtained from the
court by a creditor, shareholder or director. Alternatively, the company may itself decide to pass a liquidation
resolution – subject to the approval of a creditors’ meeting – for the company to be wound-up (a Creditors
Voluntary Liquidation). Either way, the result of both these procedures is the winding-up of the company. Neither
process makes any attempt to rescue or sustain the company as a legal entity.
The Insolvency Act 1986 also introduced three new procedures that held out the possibility of a company being
brought back to life as a viable entity. These measures represented an attempt to emulate the ‘rescue culture’
that characterised the corporate sector in the US.
The first of these procedures – ‘company voluntary arrangements’ (CVAs) – provides a way in which a company
in financial difficulty can come to a binding agreement with its creditors.
The second procedure – ‘administration’ – offers companies a breathing space during which creditors are
restrained from taking action against them. During this period, an administrator is appointed by a court to put
forward proposals to deal with the company’s financial difficulties.
A third option – ‘administrative receivership’ – permits the appointment of a receiver by certain creditors (normally
the holders of a floating charge) with the objective of ensuring repayment of secured debts.
The Enterprise Act 2002 attempted to embed a rescue culture by creating entry routes into administration that
did not require a court order, and simplified the means by which a company could ‘emerge’ from administration.
It also prohibited – with certain exceptions – the right of creditors to appoint an administrative receiver (which
had previously blocked a company’s ability to opt for administration).
In addition, the Act explicitly established a ‘hierarchy of purposes’ for the administration process. The primary
duty of administrators was defined as rescuing the company as a going concern (a duty that does not exist for
an administrative receiver). Only if this is not practicable – or not in the interests of creditors as a whole – is
the administrator allowed to consider other options, such as realising the value of property in order to make a
distribution to creditors.
US Bankruptcy laws
The English bankruptcy system was the model for bankruptcy laws in the English colonies in America and in the
American states after independence from England in 1776.
Early American bankruptcy laws were only available to merchants and generally involved imprisonment until
debts were paid or until property was liquidated or creditors agreed to the release of the debtor. The laws were
enacted by each individual state and were inconsistent and discriminatory. For example, the laws and courts
of one state might not enforce debts owed to citizens of other states or debts of certain types. The system
was not uniform and some states became known as debtor’s havens because of their unwillingness to enforce
commercial obligations.
The lack of uniformity in bankruptcy and debt enforcement laws hindered business and commerce between
the states. The United States Constitution as adopted in 1789 provides in Article I, Section 8, Clause 4 that the
states granted to Congress the power to establish uniform laws on the subject of bankruptcies throughout the
United States.
However, until 1898 there was no bankruptcy law in continuous effect in the United States. The Congress
enacted temporary bankruptcy statutes in 1800, 1841 and 1867 to deal with economic downturns. However,
those laws were temporary measures and were repealed as soon as economic conditions stabilized. The Act of
22 PP-IL&P
1800 was repealed in 1803. The Act of 1841 was repealed in 1843 and the Act of 1867 only lasted until 1878.
These early laws only permitted merchants, traders, bankers and factors to be placed in bankruptcy proceedings.
The Acts of 1800 and 1841 vested jurisdiction in the federal district courts. The district court judges were given
the power to appoint commissioners or assignees to take charge of and liquidate a debtor’s property.
A permanent bankruptcy statute was not enacted until 1898. The National Bankruptcy Act of 1898 was based
upon the liquidation of a debtor’s non-exempt assets to pay creditors. In 1938 the law was amended to provide
for the rehabilitation or reorganization of a debtor as an alternative to liquidation of assets. The Bankruptcy
Act of 1898, together with its amendments, was known as the Bankruptcy Act. Under the Bankruptcy Act, the
district court had jurisdiction over bankruptcy cases, but could appoint a referee in bankruptcy to oversee the
administration of bankruptcy cases, the allowance of claims and the distribution of payments to creditors. The
Bankruptcy Act governed bankruptcy in the United States for 80 years.
After a series of critical studies and review of the then existing law and practice, Congress passed the Bankruptcy
Reform Act of 1978.
Since 1978
The US Congress enacted the “Bankruptcy Code” in 1978. The Bankruptcy Code, which is codified as title 11
of the United States Code, has been amended several times since its enactment. It is the uniform federal law
that governs all bankruptcy cases.
The procedural aspects of the bankruptcy process are governed by the Federal Rules of Bankruptcy Procedure
(often called the “Bankruptcy Rules”) and local rules of each bankruptcy court. The Bankruptcy Rules contain a
set of official forms for use in bankruptcy cases. The Bankruptcy Code and Bankruptcy Rules (and local rules)
set forth the formal legal procedures for dealing with the debt problems of individuals and businesses.
Six basic types of bankruptcy cases are provided for under the Bankruptcy Code.
• Chapter 7 bankruptcy leading to liquidation. In this type of bankruptcy, a court-appointed trustee or
administrator takes possession of any nonexempt assets, liquidates these assets (for example, by
selling at an auction), and then uses the proceeds to pay creditors.
• Chapter 9, entitled Adjustment of Debts of a Municipality, provides essentially for reorganization. Only
a “municipality” may file under chapter 9, which includes cities and towns, as well as villages, counties,
taxing districts, municipal utilities, and school districts.
• Chapter 11 entitled Reorganization, ordinarily is used by commercial enterprises that desire to continue
operating a business and repay creditors concurrently through a court-approved plan of reorganization..
• Chapter 12 allows a family farmer or fisherman to continue to operate the business while the plan is
being carried out.
• Chapter 13 enables individuals with regular income to develop a plan to repay all or part of their debts.
Under this chapter, debtors propose a repayment plan to make installments to creditors over three to
five years.
• Chapter 15 is to provide effective mechanisms for dealing with insolvency cases involving debtors,
assets, claimants, and other parties of interest involving more than one country.
Lesson 1 n Insolvency – Concepts and Evolution 23
24 PP-IL&P
Lesson 2
Introduction to Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code
INTRODUCTION
The words “Insolvency” and “Bankruptcy” are generally used interchangeably in common parlance but there is
a marked distinction between the two. Insolvency and bankruptcy are not synonymous.
The term “insolvency” notes the state of one whose assets are insufficient to pay his debts; or his general
inability to pay his debts. The term “insolvency” is used in a restricted sense to express the inability of a party
to pay his debts as they become due in the ordinary course of business.
The word “bankruptcy” the condition of insolvency. It is a legal status of a person or an entity who cannot repay
debts to creditors. The bankruptcy process begins with filing of a petition in a court or before an appropriate
authority designated for this purpose. The debtor’s assets are then evaluated and used to pay the creditors in
accordance with law.
Therefore, while insolvency is the inability of debtors to repay their debts, the bankruptcy, on the other hand, is
a formal declaration of insolvency in accordance with law of the land. Insolvency describes a situation where
the debtor is unable to meet his/her obligations and bankruptcy occurs when a court determines insolvency, and
gives legal orders for it to be resolved. Thus insolvency is a state and bankruptcy is the conclusion.
The term insolvency is used for individuals as well as organisations/corporates. If insolvency is not resolved, it
leads to bankruptcy in case of individuals and liquidation in case of corporates.
Section 79(4) of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 defines the term “bankruptcy” as the state of
being bankrupt.
(a) a debtor who has been adjudged as bankrupt by a bankruptcy order under section 126;
(b) each of the partners of a firm, where a bankruptcy order under section 126 has been made against a
firm; or
Liquidation, on the other hand, in its general sense, means closure or winding up of an corporation or an
incorporated entity through legal process on account of its inability to meet its obligations or to pay its debts.
In order to clear the indebtedness, the assets are sold at the most reasonable rates by a competent liquidator
appointed in this regard.
25
26 PP-IL&P
Court at Fort Williams (Calcutta), Madras and Recorder’s Court at Bombay as the need for an insolvency law
was first felt in Presidency Towns of Calcutta, Bombay and Madras where the British majorly carried on their
trade. These Courts were empowered to make rules and grant relief to insolvent debtors.
Later insolvency courts were established in the Presidency-towns when Statute 9 (Geo. IV c. 73) was passed in
1828. This Act of 1828 marks the beginning of special insolvency legislation in India. The insolvency court had a
distinct existence although the court was presided over by a Judge of the Supreme Court. The Act of 1828 was
originally intended to remain in force for a period of four years but subsequent legislation extended its duration
up to 1848. The Provisions of the Indian Insolvency Act was passed in 1848 and remained in force until the
enactment of the Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909. Later Provisional Insolvency Act was passed in 1920.
The Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909 and Provisional Insolvency Act, 1920 were two major enactments
that dealt with personal insolvency but the two differ in respect of their territorial jurisdiction. While Presidency
Towns Insolvency Act, 1909 applied in Presidency towns of Calcutta, Bombay and Madras, the Provincial
Insolvency Act, 1920 applied to all provinces of India. These two Acts were applicable to individuals as well as
partnership firms.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 has repealed both the Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909
and the Provisional Insolvency Act, 1920.
Before the enactment of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the provisions relating to insolvency and
bankruptcy were fragmented and there was no single law to deal with insolvency and bankruptcy in India.
Before the enactment of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 the following Acts dealt with insolvency
and Bankruptcy in India:
• The Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909
• Provisional Insolvency Act, 1920
• Indian Partnership Act, 1932
• The Companies Act, 1956
• The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (SICA)
• The Recovery of Debts due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 (RDDBFI Act)
• The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Securities Interest Act,
2002 (SARFESI Act, 2002)
• The Companies Act, 2013
Under the Constitution of India ‘Bankruptcy & Insolvency’ is provided in Entry 9 of List III (Concurrent List) in
the Seventh Schedule to the Constitution. Hence both the Centre and State Governments are authorised to
make laws on the subject.
2 1981 Tiwari Committee Following the recommendations of the Tiwari Committee, the
Government of India enacted the Sick Industrial Companies
(Special Provisions) Act, 1985, (SICA) in order to provide
for timely detection of sickness in industrial companies and
for expeditious determination of preventive and remedial
measures.
3 1991 Narasimham Committee I The government enacted Recovery of Debts Due to Banks
and Financial Institutions (RDDBFI) Act, 1993
4 1998 Narasimham Committee II The committee’s recommendations led to the enactment of
the Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets
and Enforcement of Security Interest Act (SARFAESI), 2002.
5 1999 Justice Eradi Committee Recommended setting up of a National Company Law
Tribunal (NCLT) and proposed repeal of SICA.
6 2001 N L Mitra Committee Proposed a comprehensive bankruptcy code.
7 2005 J J Irani Committee The Committee proposed significant changes to make the
restructuring and liquidation process speedier, efficient
and effective and accordingly amendments were made to
(RDDBFI) Act, 1993 and (SARFAESI), 2002.
8 2008 Raghuram Rajan Committee Proposed improvements to credit infrastructure
9 2013 Financial Sector Legislative Recommended changes in Indian Financial Sector.
Reforms Commission
10 2014 Bankruptcy Law Reforms Reviewed the existing bankruptcy and insolvency framework
committee (BLRC) in the country and proposed the enactment of Insolvency
and Bankruptcy Code as a uniform and comprehensive
legislation on the subject.
Recovery Tribunal (DRT) and National Company Law Tribunal (NCLT) and their respective Appellate Tribunals.
Liquidation of companies was handled by the High Courts. Individual bankruptcy and insolvency was dealt with
under the Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909, and the Provincial Insolvency Act, 1920.
The liquidation of companies was handled under various laws and different authorities such as High Court,
NCLT (National Company Law Tribunal) and Debt Recovery Tribunal had overlapping jurisdiction which was
adversely affecting the debt recovery process.
The objective of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code is to consolidate and amend the laws relating to
reorganization and insolvency resolution of corporate persons, partnership firms and individuals in a time bound
manner. An effective legal framework for timely resolution of insolvency and bankruptcy will not only encourage
entrepreneurship but will also improve Ease of Doing Business, and facilitate more investments leading to
higher economic growth and development.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 extends to the whole of India. However, Part III of the Code does
not extend to the State of Jammu and Kashmir.
Section 1 of the Code provides that the Central Government may appoint different dates for different provisions
of this Code and any reference in any such provision to the commencement of this Code shall be construed
as a reference to the commencement of that provision.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 consolidates the existing framework by creating a single law
for insolvency and bankruptcy. The Code applies to companies, partnerships, limited liability partnerships,
individuals and any other body which the central government may specify.
Section 2 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 as amended vide the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code (Amendment) Act, 2018 provides that the provisions of the Code shall apply to –
(a) any company incorporated under the Companies Act, 2013 or under any previous company law,
(b) any other company governed by any special Act for the time being in force,
(c) any Limited Liability Partnership incorporated under the Limited Liability Partnership Act, 2008,
(d) such other body incorporated under any law for the time being in force, as the Central Government
may, by notification, specify in this behalf,
(e) personal guarantors to corporate debtors,
(f) partnership firms and proprietorship firms; and
(g) individuals, other than persons referred to in clause (e)
in relation to their insolvency, liquidation, voluntary liquidation or bankruptcy, as the case may be.
The Insolvency and bankruptcy Code, 2016 is one of the biggest economic reforms which provides a uniform
and comprehensive insolvency legislation covering corporates, partnerships and individuals (other than
financial firms). The Code gives both the creditors and debtors the power to initiate proceeding. It has helped
India achieve a historic 30-spot jump in the ease of doing business rankings by consolidating the law and
providing for resolution of insolvencies in a time-bound manner.
Lesson 2 n Introduction to Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code 29
Part III Insolvency Resolution and Bankruptcy for Individuals and Partnership Firms
• Chapter I Preliminary (Sections 78 to 79)
• Chapter II Fresh Start Process (Sections 80 to 93)
• Chapter III Insolvency Resolution Process (Sections 94 to 120)
• Chapter IV Bankruptcy Order for Individuals and Partnership Firms (Sections 121 to 148)
• Chapter V Administration and Distribution of the Estate of the Bankrupt (Sections 149 to 178)
• Chapter VI Adjudicating Authority for Individuals and Partnership Firms (Sections 179 to 187)
30 PP-IL&P
To regulate the working of Insolvency Professional Agencies (IPAs), the Bankruptcy Board of India
(IBBI) has framed the following regulations in exercise of the powers conferred by the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016:
• The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India (Model Bye-Laws and Governing Board of
Insolvency Professional Agencies) Regulations, 2016 and
• The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India (Insolvency Professional Agencies)
Regulations, 2016.
4. The Insolvency Professionals control the assets of the debtor during the insolvency resolution process.
The insolvency professional verifies the claims of the creditors, constitutes a committee of creditors, runs
the debtor’s business during the moratorium period and assists the creditors in finalising the revival plan.
In liquidation, the insolvency professional acts as a liquidator and bankruptcy trustee. The Insolvency
and Bankruptcy Board of India has framed the IBBI (Insolvency Professional) Regulations, 2016 to
regulate the working of Insolvency Professionals. These regulations are amended from time to time by
the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
5. While the Insolvency professionals assist in the insolvency resolution proceedings envisaged in
the Code, the Information Utilities, on the other hand, collect, collate, authenticate and disseminate
financial information. The purpose of such collection, collation, authentication and dissemination
financial information of debtors in centralised electronic databases is to facilitation swift decision
making in the resolution proceedings. The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has framed the
IBBI (Information Utilities) Regulations, 2017. These regulations are amended from time to time by
the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
6. The Code provides for the constitution of a new insolvency regulator i.e., the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Board of India (IBBI). Its role includes overseeing the functioning of insolvency intermediaries i.e.,
insolvency professionals, insolvency professional agencies and information utilities as well as
regulating the insolvency process. The members of the Board includes representatives from the central
government as well as the Reserve Bank of India. The Board is empowered to frame and implement
rules to regulate the profession as well as processes envisaged in the Code. The Bankruptcy Board
of India has also been designated as the ‘Authority’ under the Companies (Registered Valuers and
Valuation Rules), 2017 for regulation and development of the profession of valuers in the country.
7. The Code proposes two tribunals to adjudicate insolvency resolution cases. In the case of insolvency of
companies and Limited Liability Partnerships (LLPs), the adjudication authority is the National Company
Law Tribunal (NCLT), while the cases involving individuals and limited liability partnerships are handled
by the Debts Recovery Tribunals (DRTs). The insolvency proceeding will be initiated by NCLT or DRT,
as the case may be, after verification of the claims of the initiator. Appeals from NCLT orders lie to the
National Company Law Appellate Tribunal (NCLAT) and thereafter to the Supreme Court of India. For
individuals and other persons, the adjudicating authority is the DRT. Appeals from DLT orders lie to the
Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunal (DRAT) and thereafter to the Supreme Court.
To ensure that the insolvency resolution is commercially viable, the Code separates the commercial
aspects from the judicial aspects and thus limits the role of adjudicating authorities to ensuring due
process rather than adjudicating on the merits of the insolvency resolution.
8. To initiate an insolvency process for corporate debtors, the default should be at least INR 100,000.
This limit may be increased by the Government up to INR 10,000,000. For individuals and unlimited
32 PP-IL&P
partnerships, the minimum default amount is INR 1000. The Government may later revise the minimum
amount of default to a higher threshold.
9. In resolution process for corporate persons, the Code proposes two independent stages:
(i) Insolvency Resolution Process, during which the creditors assess the viability of debtor’s
business and the options for its rescue and revival.
(ii) Liquidation, in case the insolvency resolution process fails or financial creditors decide to wind
up and distribute the assets of the debtor.
10. The Code envisages two distinct processes in case of Insolvency Resolution Process (IRP) for
Individuals/Unlimited Partnerships
(i) Automatic Fresh Start
(ii) Insolvency Resolution
11. The Code provides a Fresh Start Process for individuals under which they will be eligible for a
debt waiver of up to INR 35,000. The individual will be eligible for the waiver subject to certain limits
prescribed under the Code. Under the automatic fresh start process, eligible debtors can apply to the
Debt Recovery Tribunal (DRT) for discharge from certain debts not exceeding a specified threshold,
allowing them to start afresh.
12. A financial creditor (for a defaulted financial debt) or an operational creditor (for an unpaid operational
debt) can initiate an Insolvency Resolution Process (IRP) against a corporate debtor. The defaulting
corporate debtor, its shareholders or employees, may also initiate voluntary insolvency proceedings.
The National Company Law Tribunal (NCLT) is the designated adjudicating authority in case of corporate
debtors.
In case of individuals and unlimited partnerships, the insolvency resolution process consists of
preparation of a repayment plan by the debtor. If approved by creditors, the DRT passes an order
binding the debtor and creditors to the repayment plan. If the plan is rejected or fails, the debtor or
creditors may apply for a bankruptcy order.
Section 11 of the Code disentitles the following persons to make an application to initiate corporate
insolvency resolution process:
(a) a corporate debtor undergoing a corporate insolvency resolution process; or
(b) a corporate debtor having completed corporate insolvency resolution process twelve months
preceding the date of making of the application; or
(c) a corporate debtor or a financial creditor who has violated any of the terms of resolution plan
which was approved twelve months before the date of making of an application under this
Chapter; or
(d) a corporate debtor in respect of whom a liquidation order has been made.
13. The Code provides for a time bound Insolvency Resolution Process for companies and individuals,
which is required to be completed within 180 days (subject to a one-time extension by 90 days). If the
resolution plan does not get finalised or is rejected by NCLT or DRT on technical grounds, then assets
of the debtor are sold to repay his outstanding dues.
14. The Code makes significant changes in the priority of claims for distribution of liquidation proceeds.
In case of liquidation, the assets will be distributed in the following order, in case of liquidation: (i)
fees of insolvency professional and costs related to the resolution process, (ii) workmen’s dues for
the preceding 24 months and secured creditors, (iii) employee wages, (iv) unsecured creditors, (v)
Lesson 2 n Introduction to Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code 33
government dues and remaining secured creditors (any remaining debt if they enforce their collateral),
(vi) any remaining debt, and (vii) shareholders.
Before the enactment of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, the Government dues were immediately
below the claims of secured creditors and workmen in order of priority. Now the Central and State
Government’s dues stand below the claims of secured creditors, workmen dues, employee dues and
other unsecured financial creditors.
15. The Code provides for the creation of Insolvency and Bankruptcy Fund. Section 224 of the Code
provides that the following amounts shall be credited to the fund
(a) the grants made by the Central Government for the purposes of the Fund;
(b) the amount deposited by persons as contribution to the Fund;
(c) the amount received in the Fund from any other source; and
(d) the interest or other income received out of the investment made from the Fund.
Section 224(3) further provides that a person who has contributed any amount to the Fund may, in
the event of proceedings initiated in respect of such person under the Code before an Adjudicating
Authority, make an application to such Adjudicating Authority for withdrawal of funds not exceeding
the amount contributed by it, for making payments to workmen, protecting the assets of such persons,
meeting the incidental costs during the proceedings or such other purposes as may be prescribed.
16. The Code specifies stringent penalties for certain offences such as concealing property in case of
corporate insolvency. The imprisonment in such cases may extend up to five years, or a fine of up to
one crore rupees, or both.
17. In case of cross-border insolvency proceedings, the central government may enter into bilateral
agreements and reciprocal arrangements with other countries to enforce provisions of the Code.
The Code repeals the Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909 and the Provincial Insolvency Act, 1920.
In addition, it amends the following 11 Acts:
• The Indian Partnership Act, 1932
• The Central Excise Act, 1944
• The Income-tax Act, 1961
• The Customs Act, 1962
• The Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993
• The Finance Act, 1994
• The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002
• The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Repeal Act, 2003
• The Payment and Settlement Systems Act, 2007
• The Limited Liability Partnership Act, 2008
• The Companies Act, 2013
on 1st October 2016. It is a unique regulator which regulates a profession as well as processes under the Code.
Its role includes overseeing the functioning of insolvency intermediaries i.e., insolvency professionals, insolvency
professional agencies and information utilities. The Board is responsible for implementation of the Code that
consolidates and amends the laws relating to insolvency resolution of corporate persons, partnership firms
and individuals in a time bound manner. The Board is empowered to frame and enforce rules for various
processes under the Code, namely, corporate insolvency resolution, corporate liquidation, individual insolvency
resolution and individual bankruptcy.
Section 188(2) of the Code provides that the Board shall be a body corporate having perpetual succession
and a common seal, with power, subject to the provisions of this Code, to acquire, hold and dispose of
property, both movable and immovable, and to contract, and shall, by the said name, sue or be sued. As
per section 189(4), the term of office of the Chairperson and members (other than ex officio members) shall
be five years or till they attain the age of sixty-five years, whichever is earlier, and they shall be eligible for
reappointment.
and information utilities and pass such orders as may be required for compliance of the provisions of
this Code and the regulations issued hereunder.
(g) Monitor the performance of insolvency professional agencies, insolvency professionals and information
utilities and pass any directions as may be required for compliance of the provisions of this Code and
the regulations issued hereunder.
(h) Call for any information and records from the insolvency professional agencies, insolvency professionals
and information utilities.
(i) Publish such information, data, research studies and other information as may be specified by
regulations.
(j) Specify by regulations the manner of collecting and storing data by the information utilities and for
providing access to such data.
(k) Collect and maintain records relating to insolvency and bankruptcy cases and disseminate information
relating to such cases.
(l) Constitute such committees as may be required including in particular the committees laid down in
Section 197.
(m) Promote transparency and best practices in its governance.
(n) Maintain websites and such other universally accessible repositories of electronic information as may
be necessary.
(o) Enter into memorandum of understanding with any other statutory authorities
(p) Issue necessary guidelines to the insolvency professional agencies, insolvency professionals and
information utilities.
(q) Specify mechanism for redressal of grievances against insolvency professionals, insolvency professional
agencies and information utilities and pass orders relating to complaints filed against the aforesaid for
compliance of the provisions of this Code and the regulations issued hereunder.
(r) Conduct periodic study, research and audit the functioning and performance of to the insolvency
professional agencies, insolvency professionals and information utilities at such intervals as may be
specified by the Board.
(s) Specify mechanisms for issuing regulations, including the conduct of public consultation processes
before notification of any regulations.
(t) Make regulations and guidelines on matters relating to insolvency and bankruptcy as may be required
under this Code, including mechanism for time bound disposal of the assets of the corporate debtor or
debtor.
(u) Perform such other functions as may be prescribed.
Section 196(2) of the Code further provides that the Board may make model bye-laws to be to adopted by
insolvency professional agencies which may provide for:
(a) The minimum standards of professional competence of the members of insolvency professional
agencies.
(b) The standards for professional and ethical conduct of the members of insolvency professional agencies.
(c) Requirements for enrolment of persons as members of insolvency professional agencies which shall be
non-discriminatory.
36 PP-IL&P
Explanation.– For the purposes of this clause, the term “non-discriminatory” means lack of discrimination
on the grounds of religion, caste, gender or place of birth and such other grounds as may be specified.
(d) The manner of granting membership.
(e) Setting up of a governing board for internal governance and management of insolvency professional
agency in accordance with the regulations specified by the Board.
(f) The information required to be submitted by members including the form and the time for submitting
such information.
(g) The specific classes of persons to whom services shall be provided at concessional rates or for no
remuneration by members.
(h) The grounds on which penalties may be levied upon the members of insolvency professional agencies
and the manner thereof.
(i) A fair and transparent mechanism for redressal of grievances against the members of insolvency
professional agencies.
(j) The grounds under which the insolvency professionals may be expelled from the membership of
insolvency professional agencies.
(k) The quantum of fee and the manner of collecting fee for inducting persons as its members.
(l) The procedure for enrolment of persons as members of insolvency professional agency.
(m) The manner of conducting examination for enrolment of insolvency professionals.
(n) The manner of monitoring and reviewing the working of insolvency professional who are members.
(o) The duties and other activities to be performed by members.
(p) The manner of conducting disciplinary proceedings against its members and imposing penalties.
(q) The manner of utilising the amount received as penalty imposed against any insolvency professional.
Section 196(3) states that the Board shall have the same powers as are vested in a civil court under the Code
of Civil Procedure, 1908, while trying a suit, in respect of the following matters, namely:
(a) The discovery and production of books of account and other documents, at such place and such time
as may be specified by the Board.
(b) Summoning and enforcing the attendance of persons and examining them on oath.
(c) Inspection of any books, registers and other documents of any person at any place.
(d) Issuing of commissions for the examination of witnesses or documents.
Following are the Insolvency Professional Agencies (IPAs) designated under the Code :
• The Indian Institute of Insolvency Professionals of ICAI
• ICSI Institute of Insolvency Professionals and
• Insolvency Professional Agency of Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Section 199 of the Code provides that save as otherwise provided in this Code, no person shall carry on
its business as insolvency professional agencies under this Code and enrol insolvency professionals as its
members except under and in accordance with a certificate of registration issued in this behalf by the Board.
According to Section 204 of the Code, an insolvency professional agencies perform the following functions,
namely:
(a) grant membership to persons who fulfil all requirements set out in its byelaws on payment of membership
fee;
(b) lay down standards of professional conduct for its members;
(c) monitor the performance of its members;
(d) safeguard the rights, privileges and interests of insolvency professionals who are its members;
(e) suspend or cancel the membership of insolvency professionals who are its members on the grounds
set out in its bye-laws;
(f) redress the grievances of consumers against insolvency professionals who are its members; and
(g) publish information about its functions, list of its members, performance of its members and such other
information as may be specified by regulations.
jurisdiction over the place where the individual debtor actually and voluntarily resides or carries on business or
personally works for gain and can entertain an application under this Code regarding such person.
Section 179(2) of the Code further provides that the Debt Recovery Tribunal shall, have jurisdiction to entertain
or dispose of –
(a) any suit or proceeding by or against the individual debtor;
(b) any claim made by or against the individual debtor;
(c) any question of priorities or any other question whether of law or facts, arising out of or in relation to
insolvency and bankruptcy of the individual debtor or firm under this Code.
Section 180 of the Code excludes the jurisdiction of civil courts. The section provides that no civil court or
authority shall have jurisdiction to entertain any suit or proceedings in respect of any matter on which the Debt
Recovery Tribunal or the Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunal has jurisdiction under this Code.
Thus, the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code proposes two tribunals to adjudicate insolvency resolution cases. In
the case of insolvency of companies and Limited Liability Partnerships (LLPs), the adjudication authority is the
National Company Law Tribunal (NCLT), while the cases involving individuals and limited liability partnerships
are handled by the Debts Recovery Tribunals (DRTs).
Appeals from NCLT orders lie to the National Company Law Appellate Tribunal (NCLAT) and thereafter to the
Supreme Court of India. For individuals and other persons, the adjudicating authority is the DRT. Appeals from
DLT orders lie to the Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunal (DRAT) and thereafter to the Supreme Court.
9. “Creditor” means any person to whom a debt is owed and includes a financial creditor, an operational
creditor, a secured creditor, an unsecured creditor and a decree holder [Section 3(10)].
10. “Debt” means a liability or obligation in respect of a claim which is due from any person and includes a
financial debt and operational debt [Section 3(11)].
11. “Default” means non-payment of debt when whole or any part or instalment of the amount of debt has
become due and payable and is not [paid] by the debtor or the corporate debtor, as the case may be
[Section 3(12)].
Section 3(12) of the Code was amended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second
Amendment) Act, 2018. The aforesaid amendment substituted the word “repaid” with the word “paid”
in section.
12. “Financial Information”, in relation to a person, means one or more of the following categories of
information, namely:–
(a) records of the debt of the person;
(b) records of liabilities when the person is solvent;
(c) records of assets of person over which security interest has been created;
(d) records, if any, of instances of default by the person against any debt;
(e) records of the balance sheet and cash-flow statements of the person; and
(f) such other information as may be specified [Section 3(13)].
13. “Financial Institution” means –
(a) a scheduled bank;
(b) financial institution as defined in section 45-I of the Reserve Bank of India Act, 1934;
(c) public financial institution as defined in clause (72) of section 2 of the Companies Act, 2013; and
(d) such other institution as the Central Government may by notification specify as a financial
institution [Section 3(14)].
14. “Financial Product” means securities, contracts of insurance, deposits, credit arrangements including
loans and advances by banks and financial institutions, retirement benefit plans, small savings
instruments, foreign currency contracts other than contracts to exchange one currency (whether Indian
or not) for another which are to be settled immediately, or any other instrument as may be prescribed
[Section 3(15)].
15. “Financial Service” includes any of the following services, namely:–
(a) accepting of deposits;
(b) safeguarding and administering assets consisting of financial products, belonging to another
person, or agreeing to do so;
(c) effecting contracts of insurance;
(d) offering, managing or agreeing to manage assets consisting of financial products belonging to
another person;
(e) rendering or agreeing, for consideration, to render advice on or soliciting for the purposes of –
(i) buying, selling, or subscribing to, a financial product;
42 PP-IL&P
25. “Transaction” includes an agreement or arrangement in writing for the transfer of assets, or funds,
goods or services, from or to the corporate debtor [Section 3(33)].
26. “Transfer” includes sale, purchase, exchange, mortgage, pledge, gift, loan or any other form of transfer
of right, title, possession or lien [Section 3(34)].
27. “Transfer of Property” means transfer of any property and includes a transfer of any interest in the
property and creation of any charge upon such property [Section 3(35)].
(d) the amount of any liability in respect of any lease or hire purchase contract which is deemed
as a finance or capital lease under the Indian Accounting Standards or such other accounting
standards as may be prescribed;
(e) receivables sold or discounted other than any receivables sold on nonrecourse basis;
(f) any amount raised under any other transaction, including any forward sale or purchase agreement,
having the commercial effect of a borrowing;
Explanation – For the purposes of this sub-clause,
(i) any amount raised from an allottee under a real estate project shall be deemed to be an
amount having the commercial effect of a borrowing; and
(ii) the expressions, “allottee” and “real estate project” shall have the meanings respectively
assigned to them in clauses (d) and (zn) of section 2 of the Real Estate (Regulation and
Development) Act, 2016.
[The above Explanation to clause (f) of Section 5(8) was added vide the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018.
(g) any derivative transaction entered into in connection with protection against or benefit from
fluctuation in any rate or price and for calculating the value of any derivative transaction, only the
market value of such transaction shall be taken into account;
(h) any counter-indemnity obligation in respect of a guarantee, indemnity, bond, documentary letter
of credit or any other instrument issued by a bank or financial institution;
(i) the amount of any liability in respect of any of the guarantee or indemnity for any of the items
referred to in sub-clauses (a) to (h) of this clause [Section 5(8)].
8. “Financial Position”, in relation to any person, means the financial information of a person as on a
certain date [Section 5(9)].
9. “Information Memorandum” means a memorandum prepared by resolution professional under sub-
section (1) of section 29 [Section 5(10)].
10. “Initiation Date” means the date on which a financial creditor, corporate applicant or operational
creditor, as the case may be, makes an application to the Adjudicating Authority for initiating corporate
insolvency resolution process [Section 5(11)].
11. “Insolvency Commencement Date” means the date of admission of an application for initiating
corporate insolvency resolution process by the Adjudicating Authority under sections 7, 9 or section 10,
as the case may be
[Provided that where the interim resolution professional is not appointed in the order admitting application
under section 7, 9 or 10, the insolvency commencement date shall be the date on which such interim
resolution professional is appointed by the Adjudicating Authority] [Section 5(12)].
[The above proviso was added vide the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment)
Act, 2018.
12. “Insolvency Resolution Process Costs” means –
(a) the amount of any interim finance and the costs incurred in raising such finance;
(b) the fees payable to any person acting as a resolution professional;
(c) any costs incurred by the resolution professional in running the business of the corporate debtor
as a going concern;
Lesson 2 n Introduction to Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code 45
(d) any costs incurred at the expense of the Government to facilitate the insolvency resolution
process; and
(e) any other costs as may be specified by the Board [Section 5(13)].
13. “Insolvency Resolution Process Period” means the period of one hundred and eighty days beginning
from the insolvency commencement date and ending on one hundred and eightieth day [Section 5(14)].
14. “Interim Finance” means any financial debt raised by the resolution professional during the insolvency
resolution process period [Section 5(15)].
15. “Liquidation Cost” means any cost incurred by the liquidator during the period of liquidation subject
to such regulations, as may be specified by the Board [Section 5(16)].
16. “Liquidation Commencement Date” means the date on which proceedings for liquidation commence
in accordance with section 33 or section 59, as the case may be [Section 5(17)].
17. “Liquidator” means an insolvency professional appointed as a liquidator in accordance with the
provisions of Chapter III or Chapter V of this Part, as the case may be [Section 5(18)].
18. “Operational Creditor” means a person to whom an operational debt is owed and includes any person
to whom such debt has been legally assigned or transferred [Section 5(20)].
19. “Operational Debt” means a claim in respect of the provision of goods or services including employment
or a debt in respect of the payment of dues arising under any law for the time being in force and payable
to the Central Government, any State Government or any local authority [Section 5(21)].
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 substituted the word
“repayment” with “payment” in Section 5(21) of the Code.
20. “Personal Guarantor” means an individual who is the surety in a contract of guarantee to a corporate
debtor [Section 5(22)].
21. “Personnel” includes the directors, managers, key managerial personnel, designated partners and
employees, if any, of the corporate debtor [Section 5(23)].
22. “Related Party”, in relation to a corporate debtor, means –
(a) a director or partner of the corporate debtor or a relative of a director or partner of the corporate
debtor;
(b) a key managerial personnel of the corporate debtor or a relative of a key managerial personnel of
the corporate debtor;
(c) a limited liability partnership or a partnership firm in which a director, partner, or manager of the
corporate debtor or his relative is a partner;
(d) a private company in which a director, partner or manager of the corporate debtor is a director and
holds along with his relatives, more than two per cent. of its share capital;
(e) a public company in which a director, partner or manager of the corporate debtor is a director and
holds along with relatives, more than two per cent. of its paid-up share capital;
(f) anybody corporate whose board of directors, managing director or manager, in the ordinary
course of business, acts on the advice, directions or instructions of a director, partner or manager
of the corporate debtor;
(g) any limited liability partnership or a partnership firm whose partners or employees in the ordinary
course of business, acts on the advice, directions or instructions of a director, partner or manager
of the corporate debtor;
46 PP-IL&P
(h) any person on whose advice, directions or instructions, a director, partner or manager of the
corporate debtor is accustomed to act;
(i) a body corporate which is a holding, subsidiary or an associate company of the corporate debtor,
or a subsidiary of a holding company to which the corporate debtor is a subsidiary;
(j) any person who controls more than twenty per cent. of voting rights in the corporate debtor on
account of ownership or a voting agreement;
(k) any person in whom the corporate debtor controls more than twenty per cent. of voting rights on
account of ownership or a voting agreement;
(l) any person who can control the composition of the board of directors or corresponding governing
body of the corporate debtor;
(m) any person who is associated with the corporate debtor on account of –
(i) participation in policy making processes of the corporate debtor; or
(ii) having more than two directors in common between the corporate debtor and such person; or
(iii) interchange of managerial personnel between the corporate debtor and such person; or
(iv) provision of essential technical information to, or from, the corporate debtor [Section 5(24)].
23. “Related Party”, in relation to an individual, means –
(a) a person who is a relative of the individual or a relative of the spouse of the individual;
(b) a partner of a limited liability partnership, or a limited liability partnership or a partnership firm, in
which the individual is a partner;
(c) a person who is a trustee of a trust in which the beneficiary of the trust includes the individual, or
the terms of the trust confers a power on the trustee which may be exercised for the benefit of the
individual;
(d) a private company in which the individual is a director and holds along with his relatives, more
than two per cent. of its share capital;
(e) a public company in which the individual is a director and holds along with relatives, more than
two per cent. of its paid-up share capital;
(f) a body corporate whose board of directors, managing director or manager, in the ordinary course
of business, acts on the advice, directions or instructions of the individual;
(g) a limited liability partnership or a partnership firm whose partners or employees in the ordinary
course of business, act on the advice, directions or instructions of the individual;
(h) a person on whose advice, directions or instructions, the individual is accustomed to act;
(i) a company, where the individual or the individual along with its related party, own more than fifty
per cent. of the share capital of the company or controls the appointment of the board of directors
of the company.
Explanation. For the purposes of this clause, –
(a) “relative”, with reference to any person, means anyone who is related to another, in the following
manner, namely: –
(i) members of a Hindu Undivided Family, (ii) husband, (iii) wife, (iv) father, (v) mother, (vi) son,
(vii) daughter, (viii) son’s daughter and son, (ix) daughter’s daughter and son, (x) grandson’s
Lesson 2 n Introduction to Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code 47
daughter and son, (xi) granddaughter’s daughter and son, (xii) brother, (xiii) sister, (xiv)
brother’s son and daughter, (xv) sister’s son and daughter, (xvi) father’s father and mother,
(xvii) mother’s father and mother, (xviii) father’s brother and sister, (xix) mother’s brother and
sister; and
(b) wherever the relation is that of a son, daughter, sister or brother, their spouses shall also be included
[Section 5(24A) added by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018].
24. “Resolution Applicant” means a person, who individually or jointly with any other person, submits a
resolution plan to the resolution professional pursuant to the invitation made under clause (h) of sub-
section (2) of section 25 [Section 5(25)].
The above definition of “Resolution applicant” was provided by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code (Amendment) Act, 2018. Originally, the definition of “resolution Applicant” was as follows:
“Resolution Applicant” means any person who submits a resolution plan to the resolution professional.
25. “Resolution Plan” means a plan proposed by resolution applicant for insolvency resolution of the
corporate debtor as a going concern in accordance with Part II [Section 5(26)].
26. “Resolution Professional”, for the purposes of this Part, means an insolvency professional appointed
to conduct the corporate insolvency resolution process and includes an interim resolution professional
[Section 5(27)].
27. “Voting Share” means the share of the voting rights of a single financial creditor in the committee of
creditors which is based on the proportion of the financial debt owed to such financial creditor in relation
to the financial debt owed by the corporate debtor [Section 5(28)].
INTRODUCTION
Part II of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 deals with the insolvency resolution and liquidation for
corporate persons. Section 4 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that Part II of the Code
shall apply to matters relating to the insolvency and liquidation of corporate debtors where the minimum amount
of the default is one lakh rupees. The proviso to section 4 empowers the Central Government to specify, by
notification, the minimum amount of default of higher value but it shall not be more than one crore rupees.
Part II of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 lays down the following two independent stages:
(i) Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process [Sections 4 and 6 to 32] and
(ii) Liquidation [Sections 33 to 54 and Section 59]
Chapter II of Part II deals with corporate insolvency resolution process while Chapter III together with Chapter
V of Part II govern the liquidation process for corporate persons.
The expression “corporate insolvency resolution process” is not defined in the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code, 2018. The Insolvency and Bankruptcy (Application to Adjudicating Authority) Rules, 2016
defines the expression “corporate insolvency resolution process”. According to Rule 3(b), “corporate
insolvency resolution process” means the insolvency resolution process for corporate persons under
Chapter II of Part II of the Code.
In corporate insolvency resolution process, the financial creditors assess the viability of debtor’s
business and the options for its revival and rehabilitation. If the corporate insolvency resolution process fails
or the financial creditors decide that the business of the debtor cannot be carried on in a profitable manner
and it should be wound up, the debtor’s business undergoes the liquidation process.
In the liquidation process, the assets of the debtor are realised and distributed by the liquidator in
accordance with the provisions of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Chapter II of Part II (together with Chapter VII of Part II which contains provisions relating to offences and
penalties) specifically deals with corporate insolvency resolution process. The Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code, 2016 also contains a provision for Fast Track Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process in Chapter
IV of Part II of the Code and is applicable to small corporates as defined in Section 55(2) of the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
51
52 PP-IL&P
Thus in case of a default, the following people are entitled to initiate a corporate insolvency resolution process:
i) a financial creditor,
ii) an operational creditor or
iii) the corporate debtor itself.
The term “default” means non-payment of debt when whole or any part or instalment of the amount of debt has
become due and payable and is not paid by the debtor or the corporate debtor, as the case may be [Section
3(12)]. According to section 3(8), a “corporate debtor” means a corporate person who owes a debt to any
person.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 defines the expressions “financial creditor” and “operational
creditor”. According to Section 5(7), a “financial creditor” means any person to whom a financial debt is owed
and includes a person to whom such debt has been legally assigned or transferred to and according to section
5(20) an “operational creditor” means a person to whom an operational debt is owed and includes any person
to whom such debt has been legally assigned or transferred.
Thus, a “financial creditor” means any person to whom a financial debt is owed and an “operational creditor”
means a person to whom an operational debt is owed and both these expressions also include persons to
whom such debts have been legally assigned or transferred.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 also defines the expressions “financial debt” and “operational debt”
in sections 5(8) and 5(21) of the Code respectively.
According to section 5(8) of the Code, a “financial debt” means a debt along with interest, if any, which is
disbursed against the consideration for the time value of money. According to section 5(8), a financial debt
includes –
(a) money borrowed against the payment of interest;
(b) any amount raised by acceptance under any acceptance credit facility or its dematerialised equivalent;
(c) any amount raised pursuant to any note purchase facility or the issue of bonds, notes, debentures, loan
stock or any similar instrument;
(d) the amount of any liability in respect of any lease or hire purchase contract which is deemed as a
finance or capital lease under the Indian Accounting Standards or such other accounting standards as
may be prescribed;
(e) receivables sold or discounted other than any receivables sold on non-recourse basis;
(f) any amount raised under any other transaction, including any forward sale or purchase agreement,
having the commercial effect of a borrowing;
(g) any derivative transaction entered into in connection with protection against or benefit from fluctuation
in any rate or price and for calculating the value of any derivative transaction, only the market value of
such transaction shall be taken into account;
(h) any counter-indemnity obligation in respect of a guarantee, indemnity, bond, documentary letter of
credit or any other instrument issued by a bank or financial institution;
(i) the amount of any liability in respect of any of the guarantee or indemnity for any of the items referred
to in sub-clause (a) to (h) of this clause.
Lesson 3 n Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 53
The definition of “financial debt” in section 5(8) of the Code was amended vide the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018. The (Second Amendment) Act of 2018 added an Explanation in sub
clause (f) of section 5(8). The Explanation clarifies that for the purposes of sub-clause (f) any amount raised
from an allottee under a real estate project shall be deemed to be an amount having the commercial effect of
a borrowing. Thus, an allottee under a real estate project (a buyer of an under-construction residential or
commercial property) will now be considered as a financial creditor, as the amount raised from allottees for
financing a real estate project has the commercial effect of a borrowing.
The Explanation further clarifies that the expressions, “allottee” and “real estate project” shall have the
meanings respectively assigned to them in clauses (d) and (zn) of section 2 of the Real Estate (Regulation
and Development) Act, 2016.
The expression “operational debt” as defined in section 5(21) of the Code means a claim in respect of the
provision of goods or services including employment or a debt in respect of the payment of dues arising under
any law for the time being in force and payable to the Central Government, any State Government or any local
authority.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides a simple test to initiate corporate insolvency resolution
process. The Code adopts a default based test for initiating the corporate insolvency resolution process. A
default based test for initiating the insolvency resolution process permits early intervention when the corporate
debtor shows early signs of financial distress. Early recognition of financial distress is very important for timely
resolution of insolvency.
Thus, where any corporate debtor commits a default of one lakh rupees or above as provided under
section 4 of the Code, a financial creditor, an operational creditor or the corporate debtor itself may
initiate corporate insolvency resolution process in the manner as provided under Chapter II of Part II of the
Code.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 not only permits the corporate debtor itself to initiate the insolvency
resolution process once it has defaulted on a debt but also the operational creditors to initiate the insolvency
resolution process. These provisions bring the law in line with international practices, which permit unsecured
creditors (including employees, suppliers etc. who fall under the definition of operational creditors) to file for
the initiation of insolvency resolution proceedings.
(a) record of the default recorded with the information utility or such other record or evidence of
default as may be specified;
(b) the name of the resolution professional proposed to act as an interim resolution professional; and
(c) any other information as may be specified by the Board.
(4) The Adjudicating Authority shall, within fourteen days of the receipt of the application under sub-section
(2), ascertain the existence of a default from the records of an information utility or on the basis of other
evidence furnished by the financial creditor under sub-section (3).
(5) Where the Adjudicating Authority is satisfied that –
(a) a default has occurred and the application under sub-section (2) is complete, and there is no
disciplinary proceedings pending against the proposed resolution professional, it may, by order,
admit such application; or
(b) default has not occurred or the application under sub-section (2) is incomplete or any disciplinary
proceeding is pending against the proposed resolution professional, it may, by order, reject such
application:
Provided that the Adjudicating Authority shall, before rejecting the application under clause (b) of sub-
section (5), give a notice to the applicant to rectify the defect in his application within seven days of
receipt of such notice from the Adjudicating Authority.
(6) The corporate insolvency resolution process shall commence from the date of admission of the
application under sub-section (5).
(7) The Adjudicating Authority shall communicate –
(a) the order under clause (a) of sub-section (5) to the financial creditor and the corporate debtor;
(b) the order under clause (b) of sub-section (5) to the financial creditor, within seven days of admission
or rejection of such application, as the case may be.”
Filing of application against a corporate debtor before the Adjudicating Authority.– Section 7 of the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 lays down the procedure for the initiation of the corporate insolvency
resolution process by a financial creditor. Section 7(1) of the Code provides that a financial creditor either by
itself or jointly with other financial creditors, or any other person on behalf of the financial creditor, as may be
notified by the Central Government may file an application for initiating corporate insolvency resolution process
against a corporate debtor before the National Company Law Tribunal when a default has occurred.
The aforesaid section 7 of the Code was amended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second
Amendment) Act, 2018. Originally only the financial creditors were entitled to file an application for initiating
corporate insolvency resolution process against a corporate debtor but after the enactment of the Insolvency
and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018, a financial creditor or any other person on behalf of
the financial creditor, as may be notified by the Central Government, may also file an application for initiating
corporate insolvency resolution process against a corporate debtor before the National Company Law Tribunal
when a default has occurred.
The Explanation appended to section 7(1) makes it clear that for the purposes of section 7(1), a default
includes a default in respect of a financial debt owed not only to the applicant financial creditor but to any
other financial creditor of the corporate debtor. Thus, a financial creditor can file an application for corporate
insolvency resolution process even if the default is in respect of debt of another financial creditor.
Furnishing of information by the financial creditor.– Section 7(3) of the Code mandates that the financial
creditor shall, along with the application for initiating corporate insolvency resolution process, furnish a proof
Lesson 3 n Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 55
of default and the name of a resolution professional proposed to act as the interim resolution professional
in respect of the corporate debtor.
The requirement to provide proof of default aims at ensuring that financial creditors do not file frivolous
applications or applications which prematurely put the corporate debtor into insolvency resolution proceedings
for extraneous considerations.
Time frame for ascertaining the existence of default.– After the filing of the application, the National Company
Law Tribunal shall ascertain the existence of a default from the records of an information utility or on the basis of
other evidence furnished by the financial creditor within fourteen days of the receipt of the application [Section
7(4)].
Admission of application.– If the National Company Law Tribunal is satisfied as to the existence of the
default and has ensured that the application is complete and no disciplinary proceedings are pending against
the proposed resolution professional, it shall admit the application [Section 7(5)]. The National Company Law
Tribunal is not required to look into any other criteria for admission of the application.
Rejection of application.– But if the National Company Law Tribunal finds that the default has not occurred
or the application is incomplete or any disciplinary proceeding is pending against the proposed resolution
professional, it may reject the application under section 7(5)(b). Before rejecting the application under section
7(5)(b), the National Company Law Tribunal shall give a notice to the applicant to rectify the defect in the
application within seven days of receipt of such notice from the National Company Law Tribunal.
Commencement of corporate insolvency resolution process.– Sub-section (6) provides that the corporate
insolvency resolution process shall commence from the date of admission of the application under sub-section
(5) of section 7.
Communication of Order.– The NCLT shall communicate, within seven days of admission or rejection of such
application, as the case may be
(a) to the financial creditor and the corporate debtor where the application is accepted,
(b) to the financial creditor where the application is rejected.
The Central Government has made the Insolvency and Bankruptcy (Application to Adjudicating
Authority) Rules, 2016 in exercise of the powers conferred by clauses (c), (d), (e) and (f) of sub-section (1)
of section 239 read with sections 7, 8, 9 and 10 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy (Application to Adjudicating Authority) Rules, 2016 apply to matters relating
to the corporate insolvency resolution process and has come into force with effect from 1st day of December,
2016.
The rationale for a different procedure in case of operational creditor is based on the premise that the operational
debts (such as trade debts, salary or wage claims) generally tend to be of smaller amounts (in comparison to
financial debts) or are recurring in nature. The possibility of disputed debts in relation to operational creditors
is also higher in comparison to financial creditors such as banks and financial institutions.
“(1) An operational creditor may, on the occurrence of a default, deliver a demand notice of unpaid
operational debtor copy of an invoice demanding payment of the amount involved in the default to the
corporate debtor in such form and manner as may be prescribed.
(2) The corporate debtor shall, within a period of ten days of the receipt of the demand notice or copy of
the invoice mentioned in sub-section (1) bring to the notice of the operational creditor –
(a) existence of a dispute, if any, or record of the pendency of the suit or arbitration proceedings filed
before the receipt of such notice or invoice in relation to such dispute;
(b) the payment of unpaid operational debt–
(i) by sending an attested copy of the record of electronic transfer of the unpaid amount from
the bank account of the corporate debtor; or
(ii) by sending an attested copy of record that the operational creditor has encashed a cheque
issued by the corporate debtor.
Explanation.– For the purposes of this section, a “demand notice” means a notice served by an
operational creditor to the corporate debtor demanding payment of the operational debt in respect of
which the default has occurred.”
Demand notice or copy of invoice demanding payment of the debt.– Section 8 provides that in case of a
default, the operational creditor has to deliver a demand notice or a copy of an invoice demanding payment
of the debt in default to the corporate debtor. A “demand notice” means a notice served by an operational
creditor to the corporate debtor demanding payment of the operational debt in respect of which the default has
occurred. [Section 8(1)]
Existence of dispute or payment of debt.– The corporate debtor has a period of ten days from the receipt of
the demand notice or invoice to inform the operational creditor of the existence of a dispute regarding the debt
claim or of the payment of the debt by either sending
(i) an attested copy of the record of electronic transfer of the unpaid amount from the bank account of the
corporate debtor, or
(ii) an attested copy of record that the operational creditor has encashed a cheque issued by the corporate
debtor. [Section 8(2)]
The procedure established in section 8 of the Code ensures that operational creditors, whose debt claims
are usually smaller, are not prematurely putting the corporate debtor into the insolvency resolution process
or initiating the process for extraneous considerations. The procedure laid down in section 8 also facilitate
informal negotiations between such creditors and the corporate debtor. Such negotiations may result in a
restructuring of the debt outside the formal proceedings.
(a) a copy of the invoice demanding payment or demand notice delivered by the operational creditor
to the corporate debtor;
(b) an affidavit to the effect that there is no notice given by the corporate debtor relating to a dispute
of the unpaid operational debt;
(c) a copy of the certificate from the financial institutions maintaining accounts of the operational
creditor confirming that there is no payment of an unpaid operational debt by the corporate debtor,
if available;
(d) a copy of any record with information utility confirming that there is no payment of an unpaid
operational debt by the corporate debtor, if available; and
(e) any other proof confirming that there is no payment of any unpaid operational debt by the corporate
debtor or such other information, as may be prescribed.
(4) An operational creditor initiating a corporate insolvency resolution process under this section, may
propose a resolution professional to act as an interim resolution professional.
(5) The Adjudicating Authority shall, within fourteen days of the receipt of the application under sub-section
(2), by an order –
(i) admit the application and communicate such decision to the operational creditor and the corporate
debtor if, –
(a) the application made under sub-section (2) is complete;
(b) there is no payment of the unpaid operational debt;
(c) the invoice or notice for payment to the corporate debtor has been delivered by the operational
creditor;
(d) no notice of dispute has been received by the operational creditor or there is no record of
dispute in the information utility; and
(e) there is no disciplinary proceeding pending against any resolution professional proposed
under sub-section (4), if any.
(ii) reject the application and communicate such decision to the operational creditor and the corporate
debtor, if –
(a) the application made under sub-section (2) is incomplete;
(b) there has been payment of the unpaid operational debt;
(c) the creditor has not delivered the invoice or notice for payment to the corporate debtor;
(d) notice of dispute has been received by the operational creditor or there is a record of dispute
in the information utility; or
(e) any disciplinary proceeding is pending against any proposed resolution professional:
Provided that Adjudicating Authority, shall before rejecting an application under subclause (a) of clause
(ii) give a notice to the applicant to rectify the defect in his application within seven days of the date of
receipt of such notice from the Adjudicating Authority.
(6) The corporate insolvency resolution process shall commence from the date of admission of the
application under sub-section (5) of this section.”
Application by operational creditor before NCLT.– Section 9(1) of the Code provides that if the operational
creditor does not receive either the payment of the debt or a notice of existence of dispute in relation to the debt
58 PP-IL&P
claim from the corporate debtor within a period of ten days from the date of receipt of the invoice or demand
notice under section 8, he can file an application with the National Company Law Tribunal for initiating the
insolvency resolution process in accordance with section 9 of the Code.
Furnishing of information by operational creditor.– Section 9(3) of the Code lays down that such application
by the operational creditor shall be accompanied with:
(a) a copy of the invoice demanding payment or demand notice delivered by the operational creditor to the
corporate debtor;
(b) an affidavit to the effect that there is no notice given by the corporate debtor relating to a dispute of the
unpaid operational debt;
(c) a copy of the certificate from the financial institutions maintaining accounts of the operational creditor
confirming that there is no payment of an unpaid operational debt by the corporate debtor, if available;
(d) a copy of any record with information utility confirming that there is no payment of an unpaid operational
debt by the corporate debtor, if available; and
(e) any other proof confirming that there is no payment of any unpaid operational debt by the corporate
debtor or such other information, as may be prescribed.
Section 9(3) of the Code was amended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act,
2018. The (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has amended sub-clause (c) and made optional the condition of
filing certificate from financial institutions maintaining accounts of operational creditor to prove non-payment
of operational debt. The (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has also added sub-clauses (d) and (e) which
provide other means of proving non-payment of operational debt by the corporate debtor.
Admission of application.– The National Company Law Tribunal shall admit the application and communicate
such decision to the operational creditor and the corporate debtor within fourteen days of the receipt of such
application if the following conditions are fulfilled.
(a) the application made under sub-section (2) is complete,
(b) there is no payment of the unpaid operational debt,
(c) the invoice or notice for payment to the corporate debtor has been delivered by the operational creditor,
(d) notice of dispute has not been received by the operational creditor or there is no record of dispute in the
information utility, and
(e) there is no disciplinary proceeding pending against the proposed resolution professional. [Section 9(5)
(i)]
Rejection of Application.– The National Company Law Tribunal shall reject the application and communicate
such decision to the operational creditor and the corporate debtor within fourteen days of the receipt of such
application if
(a) the application is incomplete,
(b) there has been payment of the unpaid operational debt,
(c) the creditor has not delivered the invoice or notice for payment to the corporate debtor,
(d) notice of dispute has been received by the operational creditor or there is a record of dispute in the
information utility, or
(e) any disciplinary proceeding is pending against any proposed resolution professional. [Section 9(5)(ii)]
The National Company Law Tribunal shall before rejecting an application under sub-clause (a) of clause (ii) (i.e.,
Lesson 3 n Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 59
where the application is incomplete) give a notice to the applicant to rectify the defect in his application within
seven days of the date of receipt of such notice from the National Company Law Tribunal.
Commencement of corporate insolvency resolution process.– The corporate insolvency resolution process
shall commence from the date of admission of the application under sub-section (5) of section 9. [Section 9(6)]
Initiation of corporate insolvency resolution process by corporate applicant
Section 10 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides for the initiation of corporate insolvency
resolution process by the corporate debtor itself. Section 10 reads as follows:
“(1) Where a corporate debtor has committed a default, a corporate applicant thereof may file an application
for initiating corporate insolvency resolution process with the Adjudicating Authority.
(2) The application under sub-section (1) shall be filed in such form, containing such particulars and in such
manner and accompanied with such fee as may be prescribed.
(3) The corporate applicant shall, along with the application, furnish–
(a) the information relating to its books of account and such other documents for such period as may
be specified;
(b) the information relating to the resolution proposed to be appointed as an interim resolution
professional; and
(c) the special resolution passed by shareholders of the corporate debtor or the resolution passed by
at least three-fourth of the total number of partners of the corporate debtor, as the case may be,
approving filing of the application.
(4) The Adjudicating Authority shall, within a period of fourteen days of the receipt of the application, by an
order–
(a) admit the application, if it is complete and no disciplinary proceeding is pending against the
proposed resolution professional; or
(b) reject the application, if it is incomplete or any disciplinary proceeding is pending against the
proposed resolution professional:
Provided that Adjudicating Authority shall, before rejecting an application, give a notice to the applicant
to rectify the defects in his application within seven days from the date of receipt of such notice from the
Adjudicating Authority.
(5) The corporate insolvency resolution process shall commence from the date of admission of the
application under sub-section (4) of this section.”
Corporate applicant.– Section 10(1) of the Code uses the expression “corporate applicant” and not a “corporate
debtor”. According to section 5(5) of the Code, a “corporate applicant” means –
(a) corporate debtor; or
(b) a member or partner of the corporate debtor who is authorised to make an application for the corporate
insolvency resolution process under the constitutional document of the corporate debtor; or
(c) an individual who is in charge of managing the operations and resources of the corporate debtor; or
(d) a person who has the control, and supervision over the financial affairs of the corporate debtor.
Default by corporate debtor.– In case of a default by corporate debtor, a corporate applicant thereof may
file an application for initiating corporate insolvency resolution process with the Adjudicating Authority. The
authorisation of a corporate applicant to file the application for initiating corporate insolvency resolution process
60 PP-IL&P
is based on the premise that since they are the people likely to have the best information about the financial
affairs of the corporate debtor and permitting such applicants to initiate the corporate insolvency resolution
process would ensure timely intervention that is crucial for any corporate insolvency resolution process to
succeed.
The corporate applicant can only initiate the corporate insolvency resolution process upon the occurrence of
a default and not on mere likelihood of inability to pay debts. Therefore, a corporate applicant cannot trigger
the corporate insolvency resolution process prematurely to abuse the provisions of the Code. Further, as the
Code envisages the displacement of the management of the corporate debtor during the insolvency resolution
process (which can also be permanent, depending on the outcome of the resolution process), corporate
applicants would be deterred from initiating the insolvency resolution process for extraneous considerations.
Furnishing of information by corporate applicant.– Under section 10(3) of the Code, the corporate applicant
is required to furnish, along with such application, (a) the information relating to its books of account, (b) the
information relating to the resolution proposed to be appointed as an interim resolution professional, (c) the
special resolution passed by shareholders of the corporate debtor or the resolution passed by at least three-
fourth of the total number of partners of the corporate debtor, as the case may be, approving filing of the
application.
Sub-section (3) of section 10 of the Code was amended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second
Amendment) Act, 2018. The (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 provided for the requirement of special resolution
passed by the shareholders of the corporate debtor or resolution passed by at least three-fourth of the total
number of partners of the corporate debtor, as the case may be, for initiation of corporate insolvency resolution
process by corporate applicant. The (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has also amended sub-section (4) to
provide that the presence or absence of pending disciplinary proceedings against the proposed resolution
professional shall be a ground for acceptance or rejection of application for corporate insolvency resolution
process filed by the corporate applicant.
Admission or rejection of application.– The NCLT shall thereafter admit the application within fourteen days
from the date of receipt of the application if it is complete and no disciplinary proceeding is pending against the
proposed resolution professional. The NCLT shall reject the application, if it is incomplete or any disciplinary
proceeding is pending against the proposed resolution professional. The NCLT shall, before rejecting an
application give a notice to the applicant to rectify the defects in the application within seven days from the date
of receipt of such notice from the NCLT. [Section 10(4)]
Commencement of corporate insolvency resolution process.– The corporate insolvency resolution process
shall commence from the date of admission of the application under sub-section (4) of section 10.
(b) a corporate debtor having completed corporate insolvency resolution process twelve months preceding
the date of making of the application; or
(c) a corporate debtor or a financial creditor who has violated any of the terms of resolution plan which was
approved twelve months before the date of making of an application under this Chapter; or
(d) a corporate debtor in respect of whom a liquidation order has been made.
The Explanation appended to section 11 makes it clear that for the purposes of section 11, a corporate debtor
includes a corporate applicant in respect of such corporate debtor.
Thus, according to section 11, a corporate debtor which is undergoing a corporate insolvency resolution process
(at the time of such application) or has completed a corporate insolvency resolution process in the preceding
twelve months is not entitled to file an application for initiating the corporate insolvency resolution process.
Clause (a) and (b) of section 11 ensure that corporate debtors do not have repeated recourse to the corporate
insolvency resolution process in order to delay payment of debts or to keep assets out of the reach of
creditors.
Similarly, a corporate debtor or a financial creditor who has violated any of the terms of the resolution plan
that was approved twelve months before making an application for initiating the process is also not entitled to
make an application for initiating the corporate insolvency resolution process. Clause (c) aims at ensuring that
corporate debtors or financial creditors do not abuse the corporate insolvency resolution process for extraneous
considerations in addition to ensuring compliance with the terms of the resolution plan. Lastly, a corporate
debtor in respect of which a liquidation order has been passed is not allowed to initiate the insolvency resolution
process again. Thus clause (d) ensures finality of the liquidation order.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has amended sub-section (2)
of section 12 of the Code to recalibrate voting threshold from seventy-five per cent to sixty-six per cent for
extension of corporate insolvency resolution process period by committee of creditors.
On receipt of application, if the NCLT is satisfied that the subject matter of the case is such that corporate
insolvency resolution process cannot be completed within one hundred and eighty days, it may by order
extend the duration of such process beyond one hundred and eighty days by such further period as it thinks fit,
but such period cannot exceed ninety days. [Section 12(3)]
Thus, section 12 prescribe a time limit of 180 days, extendable by a further 90 days, for the completion of
corporate insolvency resolution process. The application for the extension can only be made by the resolution
professional and has to be supported by a resolution passed at a meeting of the committee of creditors by a
majority of 66 per cent of the voting shares. Any such extension of the period of corporate insolvency resolution
process under section 12 shall not be granted more than once.
“Voting share” means the share of the voting rights of a single financial creditor in the committee of creditors
which is based on the proportion of the financial debt owed to such financial creditor in relation to the financial
debt owed by the corporate debtor. [Section 5(28)]
The well-defined time limit is aimed at ensuring that commercially unviable corporate debtors are not kept in
the resolution process for long periods and are liquidated basis the decision of the financial creditors at the
earliest opportunity. The time limit would not only reduce the cost to creditors and other stakeholders (including
employees and workmen) of a long-drawn out procedure but also avoid any depletion in value of the corporate
debtor’s business/returns to creditors and other stakeholders. This would also enable promoters of failed
businesses to exit the ventures swiftly.
COMMITTEE OF CREDITORS
Section 21 and 24 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 make provisions relating to the committee
of creditors. Section 21 deals with the constitution of committee of creditors while section 24 prescribes the
modalities for the meeting of the committee of creditors.
Section 28 of the Code lists out certain actions that may be taken by the resolution professional only with the
prior approval of the committee of creditors by a vote of 66 per cent of the voting shares.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has added a new section 25A to
provide for rights and duties of authorised representative of financial creditors.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has made the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India
(Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate Persons) Regulations, 2016 in exercise of the powers
conferred under sections 5, 7, 9, 14, 15, 17, 18, 21, 24, 25, 29, 30, 196 and 208 read with section 240
of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016. These regulations make detailed provisions for effectively
regulating the Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate Persons and are amended from time to time by
the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
Lesson 3 n Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 63
“(1) The interim resolution professional shall after collation of all claims received against the corporate debtor
and determination of the financial position of the corporate debtor, constitute a committee of creditors.
(2) The committee of creditors shall comprise all financial creditors of the corporate debtor:
Provided that a financial creditor or the authorised representative of the financial creditor referred to in sub-
section (6) or sub-section (6A) or sub-section (5) of section 24, if it is a related party of the corporate debtor,
shall not have any right of representation, participation or voting in a meeting of the committee of creditors:
Provided further that the first proviso shall not apply to a financial creditor, regulated by a financial sector
regulator, if it is a related party of the corporate debtor solely on account of conversion or substitution of debt
into equity shares or instruments convertible into equity shares, prior to the insolvency commencement date.
(3) Subject to sub-sections (6) and (6A), where the corporate debtor owes financial debts to two or more
financial creditors as part of a consortium or agreement, each such financial creditor shall be part of the
committee of creditors and their voting share shall be determined on the basis of the financial debts owed
to them.
(4) Where any person is a financial creditor as well as an operational creditor,
(a) such person shall be a financial creditor to the extent of the financial debt owed by the corporate debtor,
and shall be included in the committee of creditors, with voting share proportionate to the extent of
financial debts owed to such creditor;
(b) such person shall be considered to be an operational creditor to the extent of the operational debt owed
by the corporate debtor to such creditor.
(5) Where an operational creditor has assigned or legally transferred any operational debt to a financial
creditor, the assignee or transferee shall be considered as an operational creditor to the extent of such
assignment or legal transfer.
(6) Where the terms of the financial debt extended as part of a consortium arrangement or syndicated facility
provide for a single trustee or agent to act for all financial creditors, each financial creditor may
(a) authorise the trustee or agent to act on his behalf in the committee of creditors to the extent of his voting
share;
(b) represent himself in the committee of creditors to the extent of his voting share;
(c) appoint an insolvency professional (other than the resolution professional) at his own cost to represent
himself in the committee of creditors to the extent of his voting share; or
(d) exercise his right to vote to the extent of his voting share with one or more financial creditors jointly or
severally.
(6A) Where a financial debt –
(a) is in the form of securities or deposits and the terms of the financial debt provide for appointment of a
trustee or agent to act as authorised representative for all the financial creditors, such trustee or agent
shall act on behalf of such financial creditors;
(b) is owed to a class of creditors exceeding the number as may be specified, other than the creditors
covered under clause (a) or sub-section (6), the interim resolution professional shall make an
application to the Adjudicating Authority along with the list of all financial creditors, containing the name
of an insolvency professional, other than the interim resolution professional, to act as their authorised
representative who shall be appointed by the Adjudicating Authority prior to the first meeting of the
committee of creditors;
64 PP-IL&P
(c) is represented by a guardian, executor or administrator, such person shall act as authorised
representative on behalf of such financial creditors,
and such authorised representative under clause (a) or clause (b) or clause (c) shall attend the meetings
of the committee of creditors, and vote on behalf of each financial creditor to the extent of his voting share.
(6B) The remuneration payable to the authorised representative-
(i) under clauses (a) and (c) of sub-section (6A), if any, shall be as per the terms of the financial debt or
the relevant documentation; and
(ii) under clause (b) of sub-section (6A) shall be as specified which shall be form part of the insolvency
resolution process costs.
(7) The Board may specify the manner of voting and the determining of the voting share in respect of financial
debts covered under sub-sections (6) and (6A).
(8) Save as otherwise provided in this Code, all decisions of the committee of creditors shall be taken by a
vote of not less than fifty-one per cent. of voting share of the financial creditors:
Provided that where a corporate debtor does not have any financial creditors, the committee of creditors
shall be constituted and shall comprise of such persons to exercise such functions in such manner as may
be specified.
(9) The committee of creditors shall have the right to require the resolution professional to furnish any financial
information in relation to the corporate debtor at any time during the corporate insolvency resolution process.
(10) The resolution professional shall make available any financial information so required by the committee
of creditors under sub-section (9) within a period of seven days of such requisition.”
Constitution of committee of creditors – Section 18 of the Code which lists out the duties of Interim Resolution
Professional specifically provides that the Interim Resolution Professional shall collect all information relating
to the assets, finances and operations of the corporate debtor for determining the financial position of the
corporate debtor as well as receive and collate all the claims submitted by creditors to him, pursuant to the
public announcement made under sections 13 and 15 of the Code.
Section 21(1) further provides that the Interim Resolution Professional shall after collation of all claims received
against the corporate debtor and determination of the financial position of the corporate debtor, constitute a
committee of creditors.
Composition of committee of creditors –Section 21(2) provides that the committee of creditors shall comprise
all financial creditors of the corporate debtor.
According to section 5(7) of the Code, a “financial creditor” means any person to whom a financial debt is owed
and includes a person to whom such debt has been legally assigned or transferred to.
Exclusion of related party –First proviso to section 21(2) provides that a financial creditor or the authorised
representative of the financial creditor, if it is a related party of the corporate debtor, shall not have any right of
representation, participation or voting in a meeting of the committee of creditors.
Lesson 3 n Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 65
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 also added second proviso to section
21(2) which clarifies that the first proviso shall not apply to a financial creditor, regulated by a financial sector
regulator, if it is a related party of the corporate debtor solely on account of conversion or substitution of debt
into equity shares or instruments convertible into equity shares, prior to the insolvency commencement
date.
66 PP-IL&P
According to section 3(18) of the Code, a “financial sector regulator” means an authority or body constituted
under any law for the time being in force to regulate services or transactions of financial sector and includes
the Reserve Bank of India, the Securities and Exchange Board of India, the Insurance Regulatory and
Development Authority of India, the Pension Fund Regulatory Authority and such other regulatory authorities
as may be notified by the Central Government.
The committee of creditors is composed of financial creditors of the corporate debtor as the financial creditors
have the capability to assess the commercial viability of the corporate debtor and are willing to modify the terms
of the debt contracts in negotiations between the creditors and the corporate debtor.
Operational creditors, on the other hand, are not equipped to decide on matters relating to commercial viability
of the corporate debtor, nor are they generally willing to take the risk of restructuring their debts in order to
ensure the management of operations of corporate debtor a going concern.
Where a person is both financial as well as operational creditor – Section 21(4) provides that where any
person is a financial creditor as well as an operational creditor, then such person shall be considered a financial
creditor to the extent of the financial debt owed by the corporate debtor. Such person shall be included in the
committee of creditors and shall have a voting share proportionate to the extent of financial debts owed to
such creditor.
Thus, financial creditors who are also operational creditors are given representation on the committee of
creditors only to the extent of their financial debts.
Clause (b) of sub-section (4) of section 21 clarifies that such person shall be considered to be an operational
creditor to the extent of the operational debt owed by the corporate debtor to such creditor.
According to section 5(28), “voting share” means the share of the voting rights of a single financial creditor
in the committee of creditors which is based on the proportion of the financial debt owed to such financial
creditor in relation to the financial debt owed by the corporate debtor.
Assignment or legal transfer of operational debt – Section 21(5) further provides that where an operational
creditor has assigned or legally transferred any operational debt to a financial creditor, the assignee or transferee
shall be considered as an operational creditor to the extent of such assignment or legal transfer.
Financial debts to two or more financial creditors as part of consortium or agreement – Section 21(3)
provides that subject to sub-sections (6) and (6A), where the corporate debtor owes financial debts to two or more
financial creditors as part of a consortium or agreement, each such financial creditor shall be part of the committee
of creditors and their voting share shall be determined on the basis of the financial debts owed to them.
A single trustee or agent to act for all financial creditors – Section 21(6) of the Code provides that where
the terms of the financial debt extended as part of a consortium arrangement or syndicated facility provide for
a single trustee or agent to act for all financial creditors, each financial creditor may
(a) authorise the trustee or agent to act on his behalf in the committee of creditors to the extent of his voting
share;
(b) represent himself in the committee of creditors to the extent of his voting share;
(c) appoint an insolvency professional (other than the resolution professional) at his own cost to represent
himself in the committee of creditors to the extent of his voting share; or
(d) exercise his right to vote to the extent of his voting share with one or more financial creditors jointly or
severally.
Sub-section 6A.– The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has added a
new sub-section 6A to section 21 to provide for a mechanism to allow participation of security holders, deposit
Lesson 3 n Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process 67
holders and all other classes of financial creditors which exceed a certain number, in meetings of committee of
creditors through an authorised representative.
A trustee or agent to act as authorised representative.– Where a financial debt is in the form of securities or
deposits and the terms of the financial debt provide for appointment of a trustee or agent to act as authorised
representative for all the financial creditors, such trustee or agent shall act on behalf of such financial creditors
[Section 21(6A)(a)]
Financial debt owed to a class of creditors exceeding the specified number – Where a financial debt is
owed to a class of creditors exceeding the number as may be specified, other than the creditors covered under
clause (a) or sub-section (6), the interim resolution professional shall make an application to the Adjudicating
Authority along with the list of all financial creditors, containing the name of an insolvency professional, other
than the interim resolution professional, to act as their authorised representative who shall be appointed by the
Adjudicating Authority prior to the first meeting of the committee of creditors. [Section 21(6A)(b)]
Guardian, executor or administrator – Where a financial debt is represented by a guardian, executor or
administrator, such person shall act as authorised representative on behalf of such financial creditors [Section
21(6A)(c)]
All such authorised representative under clause (a) or clause (b) or clause (c) of sub-section 6A shall attend the
meetings of the committee of creditors, and vote on behalf of each financial creditor to the extent of his voting
share.
Board to specify the manner of voting and the determining of the voting share – The Board may specify
the manner of voting and the determining of the voting share in respect of financial debts covered under sub-
sections (6) and (6A). [Section 21[(7)]
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has substituted sub-section (7).
Before its substitution, sub-section (7) stood as follows:
“(7) The Board may specify the manner of determining the voting share in respect of financial debts issued
as securities under sub-section (6).”
Remuneration payable to authorised representative – The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second
Amendment) Act, 2018 has also added sub-section (6B) to section 21. It provides that the remuneration
payable to the authorised representative under clauses (a) and (c) of sub-section (6A), if any, shall be as per
the terms of the financial debt or the relevant documentation; and under clause (b) of sub-section (6A) shall be
as specified which shall be form part of the insolvency resolution process costs.
According to section 5(13), of the Code, the “insolvency resolution process costs” means – (a) the amount
of any interim finance and the costs incurred in raising such finance;
(b) the fees payable to any person acting as a resolution professional;
(c) any costs incurred by the resolution professional in running the business of the corporate debtor as a
going concern;
(d) any costs incurred at the expense of the Government to facilitate the insolvency resolution process; and
(e) any other costs as may be specified by the Board.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has added sub-sections (6A) and (6B)
to section 21 of the Code. Sub-section (6A) provides for a mechanism to allow participation of security holders,
deposit holders and all other classes of financial creditors which exceed a certain number, in meetings of
committee of creditors through an authorised representative. Sub-section (6B) provides for remuneration
payable to such authorised representative.
68 PP-IL&P
Decisions of the committee of creditors.– Sub-section (8) to section 21 of the Code provides that except as
otherwise provided in the Code, all decisions of the committee of creditors shall be taken by a vote of not less
than fifty-one per cent of voting share of the financial creditors.
The proviso to this sub-section clarifies that in the event there are no financial creditors for a corporate debtor,
the committee of creditors shall be constituted consisting of such persons and exercise such function in such
manner as may be specified.
Financial information – The committee of creditors shall have the right to require the resolution professional to
furnish any financial information in relation to the corporate debtor at any time during the corporate insolvency
resolution process. [Section 21(9)]
The resolution professional shall make available any financial information so required by the committee of
creditors under sub-section (9) within a period of seven days of such requisition. [Section 21(10)]
According to section 3(13), “financial information”, in relation to a person, means one or more of the
following categories of information, namely:
(a) records of the debt of the person;
(b) records of liabilities when the person is solvent;
(c) records of assets of person over which security interest has been created;
(d) records, if any, of instances of default by the person against any debt;
(e) records of the balance sheet and cash-flow statements of the person; and
(f) such other information as may be specified.
(b) the amount of the aggregate debt due to workmen under sub-regulation 2(b); and
(c) the amount of the aggregate debt due to employees under sub-regulation 2(c).
(4) A committee formed under this Regulation and its members shall have the same rights, powers, duties
and obligations as a committee comprising financial creditors and its members, as the case may be.
any of the actions listed in section 28(1) without obtaining the consent of the committee of creditors, such action
shall be void. The resolution professional may also be liable to be replaced.
Section 28(1) provides that notwithstanding anything contained in any other law for the time being in force, the
resolution professional, during the corporate insolvency resolution process, shall not take any of the following
actions without the prior approval of the committee of creditors:
(a) raise any interim finance in excess of the amount as may be decided by the committee of creditors in
their meeting;
(b) create any security interest over the assets of the corporate debtor;
(c) change the capital structure of the corporate debtor, including by way of issuance of additional
securities, creating a new class of securities or buying back or redemption of issued securities in case
the corporate debtor is a company;
(d) record any change in the ownership interest of the corporate debtor;
(e) give instructions to financial institutions maintaining accounts of the corporate debtor for a debit
transaction from any such accounts in excess of the amount as may be decided by the committee of
creditors in their meeting;
(f) undertake any related party transaction;
(g) amend any constitutional documents of the corporate debtor;
(h) delegate its authority to any other person;
(i) dispose of or permit the disposal of shares of any shareholder of the corporate debtor or their nominees
to third parties;
(j) make any change in the management of the corporate debtor or its subsidiary;
(k) transfer rights or financial debts or operational debts under material contracts otherwise than in the
ordinary course of business;
(l) make changes in the appointment or terms of contract of such personnel as specified by the committee
of creditors; or
(m) make changes in the appointment or terms of contract of statutory auditors or internal auditors of the
corporate debtor.
Section 28(2) mandates that the resolution professional shall convene a meeting of the committee of creditors
and seek the vote of the creditors prior to taking any of the actions under sub-section (1).
No action under sub-section (1) shall be approved by the committee of creditors unless approved by a vote of
1[sixty-six] per cent. of the voting shares. [Section 28(3)]
(4) Where any action under sub-section (1) is taken by the resolution professional without seeking the approval
of the committee of creditors in the manner as required in this section, such action shall be void. [Section 28(4)]
(5) The committee of creditors may report the actions of the resolution professional under sub-section (4) to the
Board for taking necessary actions against him under this code. [Section 28(5)]
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has amended section 28 of the
Code to reduce the threshold for voting from 75% to 66% for approval of committee of creditors in respect
certain actions provided in sub-section (1) of section 28.
72 PP-IL&P
Lesson 4
Insolvency Resolution of Corporate
Persons
73
74 PP-IL&P
into equity shares or instruments convertible into equity shares, prior to the insolvency commencement
date.
Explanation II. – For the purposes of this clause, where a resolution applicant has an account, or an
account of a corporate debtor under the management or control of such person or of whom such person
is a promoter, classified as non-performing asset and such account was acquired pursuant to a prior
resolution plan approved under this Code, then, the provisions of this clause shall not apply to such
resolution applicant for a period of three years from the date of approval of such resolution plan by the
Adjudicating Authority under this Code;
(d) has been convicted for any offence punishable with imprisonment –
(i) for two years or more under any Act specified under the Twelfth Schedule; or
(ii) for seven years or more under any law for the time being in force:
Provided that this clause shall not apply to a person after the expiry of a period of two years from the
date of his release from imprisonment:
Provided further that this clause shall not apply in relation to a connected person referred to in clause
(iii) of Explanation I;
(e) is disqualified to act as a director under the Companies Act, 2013:
Provided that this clause shall not apply in relation to a connected person referred to in clause (iii) of
Explanation I;
(f) is prohibited by the Securities and Exchange Board of India from trading in securities or accessing the
securities markets;
(g) has been a promoter or in the management or control of a corporate debtor in which a preferential
transaction, undervalued transaction, extortionate credit transaction or fraudulent transaction has taken
place and in respect of which an order has been made by the Adjudicating Authority under this Code:
Provided that this clause shall not apply if a preferential transaction, undervalued transaction, extortionate
credit transaction or fraudulent transaction has taken place prior to the acquisition of the corporate
debtor by the resolution applicant pursuant to a resolution plan approved under this Code or pursuant to
a scheme or plan approved by a financial sector regulator or a court, and such resolution applicant has
not otherwise contributed to the preferential transaction, undervalued transaction, extortionate credit
transaction or fraudulent transaction;
(h) has executed a guarantee in favour of a creditor in respect of a corporate debtor against which an
application for insolvency resolution made by such creditor has been admitted under this Code and
such guarantee has been invoked by the creditor and remains unpaid in full or part;
(i) is subject to any disability, corresponding to clauses (a) to (h), under any law in a jurisdiction outside
India; or
(j) has a connected person not eligible under clauses (a) to (i).
Explanation I. – For the purposes of this clause, the expression “connected person” means –
(i) any person who is the promoter or in the management or control of the resolution applicant; or
(ii) any person who shall be the promoter or in management or control of the business of the corporate
debtor during the implementation of the resolution plan; or
(iii) the holding company, subsidiary company, associate company or related party of a person referred
to in clauses (i) and (ii):
Lesson 4 n Insolvency Resolution of Corporate Persons 75
Provided that nothing in clause (iii) of Explanation I shall apply to a resolution applicant where such
applicant is a financial entity and is not a related party of the corporate debtor:
Provided further that the expression “related party” shall not include a financial entity, regulated by
a financial sector regulator, if it is a financial creditor of the corporate debtor and is a related party
of the corporate debtor solely on account of conversion or substitution of debt into equity shares or
instruments convertible into equity shares, prior to the insolvency commencement date;
Explanation II – For the purposes of this section, “financial entity” shall mean the following entities
which meet such criteria or conditions as the Central Government may, in consultation with the financial
sector regulator, notify in this behalf, namely: –
(a) a scheduled bank;
(b) any entity regulated by a foreign central bank or a securities market regulator or other financial
sector regulator of a jurisdiction outside India which jurisdiction is compliant with the Financial
Action Task Force Standards and is a signatory to the International Organisation of Securities
Commissions Multilateral Memorandum of Understanding;
(c) any investment vehicle, registered foreign institutional investor, registered foreign portfolio investor or a
foreign venture capital investor, where the terms shall have the meaning assigned to them in regulation
2 of the Foreign Exchange Management (Transfer or Issue of Security by a Person Resident Outside
India) Regulations, 2017 made under the Foreign Exchange Management Act, 1999;
(d) an asset reconstruction company register with the Reserve Bank of India under section 3 of the
Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act,
2002;
(e) an Alternate Investment Fund registered with Securities and Exchange Board of India;
(f) such categories of persons as may be notified by the Central Government.
The resolution professional is required to submit each resolution plan, which conforms to the criteria in Clause
30(2), to the committee of creditors who shall approve a resolution plan by a by a vote of not less than sixty-six
percent of voting share of the financial creditors, after considering its feasibility and viability, and such other
requirements as may be specified by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
Once the resolution plan is approved by the committee of creditors, it is then presented to the adjudicating
authority for its approval.
Resolution plan by resolution applicant – Section 30(1) of the Code provides that a resolution applicant may
submit a resolution plan along with an affidavit stating that he is eligible under section 29A to the resolution
professional prepared on the basis of the information memorandum.
Requirement of filing affidavit. – The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment)
Act, 2018 amended section 30(1) of the Code. After this amendment, a resolution plan is required to be
accompanied with an affidavit by the resolution applicant stating that he is eligible under section 29A of the
Code.
Examination by resolution professional – Section 30(2) further provides that the resolution professional shall
examine each resolution plan received by him to confirm that each resolution plan –
(a) provides for the payment of insolvency resolution process costs in a manner specified by the Board in
priority to the payment of other debts of the corporate debtor;
(b) provides for the payment of the debts of operational creditors in such manner as may be specified by
the Board which shall not be less than the amount to be paid to the operational creditors in the event of
a liquidation of the corporate debtor under section 53;
(c) provides for the management of the affairs of the Corporate debtor after approval of the resolution plan;
(d) The implementation and supervision of the resolution plan;
(e) does not contravene any of the provisions of the law for the time being in force
(f) confirms to such other requirements as may be specified by the Board.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has added an Explanation to
sub-section (2) of section 30 to clarify that for the purposes of clause (e), if any approval of shareholders is
required under the Companies Act, 2013 or any other law for the time being in force for the implementation
of actions under the resolution plan, such approval shall be deemed to have been given and it shall not be
a contravention of that Act or law.
Resolution plans to be submitted to committee of creditors – The resolution professional shall present to
the committee of creditors for its approval such resolution plans which confirm the conditions referred to in sub-
section (2) of section 30. [Section 30(3)].
Approval by committee of creditors – Section 30(4) of the Code provides that the committee of creditors may
approve a resolution plan by a vote of not less than sixty-six percent of voting share of the financial creditors,
after considering its feasibility and viability, and such other requirements as may be specified by the Board.
Provided that the committee of creditors shall not approve a resolution plan, submitted before the commencement
of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Amendment) Ordinance, 2017 where the resolution applicant is
ineligible under section 29A and may require the resolution professional to invite a fresh resolution plan where
no other resolution plan is available with it:
Provided further that where the resolution applicant referred to in the first proviso is ineligible under clause (c) of
section 29A, the resolution applicant shall be allowed by the committee of creditors such period, not exceeding
Lesson 4 n Insolvency Resolution of Corporate Persons 77
thirty days, to make payment of overdue amounts in accordance with the proviso to clause (c) of section 29A:
Provided also that nothing in the second proviso shall be construed as extension of period for the purposes of
the proviso to sub-section (3) of section 12, and the corporate insolvency resolution process shall be completed
within the period specified in that subsection]:
Provided also that the eligibility criteria in section 29A as amended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code
(Amendment) Ordinance, 2018 shall apply to the resolution applicant who has not submitted resolution plan as
on the date of commencement of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Amendment) Ordinance, 2018.
Attending the meeting of committee of creditors – The resolution applicant may attend the meeting of the
committee of creditors in which the resolution plan of the applicant is considered.
Provided that the resolution applicant shall not have a right to vote at the meeting of the committee of creditors
unless such resolution applicant is also a financial creditor. [Section 30(5)]
Submission of approved resolution plan – The resolution professional shall submit the resolution plan as
approved by the committee of creditors to the Adjudicating Authority. [Section 30(6)]
Changes brought about by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 in
section 30 –
l A resolution applicant to file an affidavit stating that it is eligible under section 29A.
l Added an Explanation to sub-section (2) of section 30 to clarify that if any approval of shareholders
is required under the Companies Act, 2013 or any other law for the time being in force for the
implementation of actions under the resolution plan, such approval shall be deemed to have been
given and it shall not be a contravention of that Act or law.
l Substituted sub-section (4) of section 30, inter alia, reducing the threshold for voting from 75% to
66% for approving a resolution plan by committee of creditors.
(b) the resolution professional shall forward all records relating to the conduct of the corporate insolvency
resolution process and the resolution plan to the Board to be recorded on its database.
Securing necessary approvals –The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018
has added a new sub-section (4) to section 31. The newly added sub-section (4) provides that the resolution
applicant shall, pursuant to the resolution plan approved under sub-section (1), obtain the necessary approval
required under any law for the time being in force within a period of one year from the date of approval of the
resolution plan by the Adjudicating Authority under sub-section (1) or within such period as provided for in such
law, whichever is later.
The proviso to sub-section (4) lays down that where the resolution plan contains a provision for combination,
as referred to in section 5 of the Competition Act, 2002, the resolution applicant shall obtain the approval of the
Competition Commission of India under that Act prior to the approval of such resolution plan by the committee
of creditors.
Appeal
Section 32 of the Code deals with appeals from an order approving the resolution plan. Section 32 lays down
that any appeal from an order approving the resolution plan shall be in the manner and on the grounds laid
down in sub-section (3) of section 61.
According to section 61(3), an appeal against an order approving a resolution plan under section 31 may be
filed on the following grounds:
(i) the approved resolution plan is in contravention of the provisions of any law for the time being in force,
(ii) there has been material irregularity in exercise of the powers by the resolution professional during the
corporate insolvency resolution period,
(iii) the debts owed to operational creditors of the corporate debtor have not been provided for in the
resolution plan in the manner specified by the Board,
(iv) the insolvency resolution process costs have not been provided for repayment in priority to all other
debts, or
(v) the resolution plan does not comply with any other criteria specified by the Board.
Lesson 5
Resolution Strategies
INTRODUCTION
Corporate Restructuring is an inorganic business strategy where one or more aspects of a business are
redesigned to improve commercial efficiency, manage competition effectively, drive faster pace of growth, ensure
effective utilization of resources, and fulfilment of stakeholders’ expectations. It serves different purposes for
different companies at different points of time and may take up various forms.
Restructuring typically occurs to address challenges or it can be driven by the necessity to make financial
adjustments to its assets and liabilities. Mergers, amalgamations, acquisitions, compromises, arrangement or
reconstruction are various forms of corporate restructuring exercises. The purpose of each of these restructuring
exercises may be different but each of these exercises attempts to bring in more efficiency in the system.
Corporate Restructuring process in India is governed by the Companies Act, 2013, the Companies (Compromises,
Arrangements and Amalgamations) Rules, 2016 and various other regulatory laws such as the Income Tax Act,
1961, the Competition Act, 2002, the Foreign Exchange Management Act, 1999, the Indian and State Stamp
Acts and Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016. Chapter XV of the Companies Act, 2013 (comprising sections
230 to 240 regulates compromises, arrangement and amalgamations.
Corporate restructuring may be broadly categorised as:
1. Organisational Restructuring
2. Financial Restructuring
1. Organisational Restructuring
Organizational Restructuring may involve creation of new departments to serve growing markets or downsizing
or eliminating departments to conserve overheads. A company may undertake restructuring to focus on a
particular market segment leveraging its core competencies or may undertake restructuring to make the
organisation lean and efficient. This type of restructuring affects employees and involves layoffs or collaboration
with third parties to upgrade skills and technical know-how.
2. Financial Restructuring
Financial restructuring is the process of reorganizing the financial structure, which primarily comprises of equity
capital and debt capital. There may be several reasons (financial and non-financial) that trigger the need for
financial restructuring. Financial restructuring is undertaken either because of compulsion (to recover from
financial distress) or as part of company’s financial strategy. Financial restructuring is done for various business
reasons such as to overcome poor financial performance, to gain market share, or to seize emerging market
opportunities. Financial restructuring undertaken to recover from financial distress involves negotiations with
various stakeholders such as banks, financial institutions, creditors in order to reduce liabilities.
Corporate financial restructuring involves a considerable change in the company’s financial structure and is
undertaken for various business reasons such as:
79
80 PP-IL&P
Debt restructuring
Debt restructuring is the process of reorganizing the whole debt capital of the company in negotiation with
bankers, creditors, vendors. Debt capital of the company includes secured long term borrowing, unsecured long-
term borrowing, and short term borrowings. Debt restructuring involves a reduction of debt and an extension of
payment terms or change in terms and conditions. Debt restructuring is more commonly used as a financial tool
than compared to equity restructuring.
Restructuring includes alteration of repayment period, repayable amount, the amount of instalments, rate of
interest, roll over of credit facilities, sanction of additional credit facility, enhancement of existing credit limits,
compromise settlements.
Debt restructuring involves:
Restructuring of secured long-term borrowings – It is undertaken for reducing the cost of capital, improving
liquidity and increasing the cash flow.
Restructuring of unsecured long-term borrowing – It depends on the type of borrowing which can be in form
of public deposits, private loans (unsecured), unsecured bonds or debentures.
Restructuring of short-term borrowings – These borrowings are generally not restructured and but can be
renegotiated with new terms.
Until recently, there had been several debt restructuring mechanisms such as Framework for Revitalising
Distressed Assets, Corporate Debt Restructuring Scheme (CDR), The Joint Lenders’ Forum (JLF), Flexible
Structuring of Existing Long Term Project Loans, Strategic Debt Restructuring Scheme (SDR), Change
in Ownership outside SDR, and Scheme for Sustainable Structuring of Stressed Assets (S4A). These
schemes, based on various circulars and guidelines issued by the Reserve Bank of India (RBI), were used
as a tool for restructuring the debt of a Corporate Debtor.
In order to harmonise and simplify the framework for the resolution of stressed assets, the Reserve Bank
of India (RBI), vide a circular dated 12 February 2018 has withdrawn these schemes. The Joint Lenders’
Forum (JLF), an institutional mechanism for resolution of stressed accounts, also stands discontinued.
the purposes of corporate restructuring (mergers, demergers, amalgamations) and have rarely been employed
as a tool for debt restructuring.
Part II of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 deals with the insolvency resolution and liquidation for
corporate persons. Section 4 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that Part II of the Code
shall apply to matters relating to the insolvency and liquidation of corporate debtors where the minimum amount
of the default is one lakh rupees. The proviso to section 4 empowers the Central Government to specify, by
notification, the minimum amount of default of higher value but it shall not be more than one crore rupees.
Part II of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 lays down the following two independent stages:
(i) Corporate Insolvency Resolution Process [Sections 4 and 6 to 32] and
(ii) Liquidation [Sections 33 to 54 and Section 59]
Chapter II of Part II deals with corporate insolvency resolution process while Chapter III together with Chapter
V of Part II govern the liquidation process for corporate persons.
Under the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the resolution professional, during the corporate insolvency
resolution process, invites resolution plans from prospective Resolution Applicants. Such plans may be based
on one or more mechanisms outlined in Chapter XV of the Companies Act, 2013 as well as in accordance with
various mechanisms laid under Regulation 37 of the IBBI (Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate Persons),
Regulations, 2016 subject to the compliance of conditions as laid down under Section 30(2) of the IBC, 2016.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has made the IBBI (Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate
Persons) Regulations, 2016 to regulate the Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate Persons. Regulation
37 as substituted vide Notification No. IBBI/2017-18/GN/REG024, dated 6th February, 2018 (w.e.f. 06 February
2018) provides that a resolution plan shall provide for the measures, as may be necessary, for insolvency
resolution of the corporate debtor for maximization of value of its assets, including but not limited to the following:
(a) transfer of all or part of the assets of the corporate debtor to one or more persons;
(b) sale of all or part of the assets whether subject to any security interest or not;
(c) the substantial acquisition of shares of the corporate debtor, or the merger or consolidation of the
corporate debtor with one or more persons;
(ca) cancellation or delisting of any shares of the corporate debtor, if applicable;
(d) satisfaction or modification of any security interest;
(e) curing or waiving of any breach of the terms of any debt due from the corporate debtor;
(f) reduction in the amount payable to the creditors;
(g) extension of a maturity date or a change in interest rate or other terms of a debt due from the corporate
debtor;
(h) amendment of the constitutional documents of the corporate debtor;
(i) issuance of securities of the corporate debtor, for cash, property, securities, or in exchange for claims
or interests, or other appropriate purpose;
(j) change in portfolio of goods or services produced or rendered by the corporate debtor;
(k) change in technology used by the corporate debtor; and
(l) obtaining necessary approvals from the Central and State Governments and other authorities.
One of the best methods for corporate debt restructuring is debt-equity swap where specified shareholders
have right to exchange stock for a predetermined amount of debt (ie, bonds) in the same company. In debt-
82 PP-IL&P
equity swap debt /bonds are exchanged with shares/stock of the company. Debt-for-equity swaps can be used
as a tool for restructuring under sections 230–231 of the Companies Act, 2013 Act and the resolutions plans
that may be submitted by the Resolution Applicants to the Resolution Professional. Under the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, a resolution plan requires the consent of the Committee of Creditors and thereafter the
approval of the Adjudicating Authority.
Equity Restructuring
Equity Restructuring involves reorganization of equity capital. The following comes under equity restructuring:
• Alteration of share capital
• Reduction of share capital
• Buy-back of shares
1. Alteration of Share Capital
– Legal Provisions
• Section 61 to 64 read with Section 13 and 14 of the Companies Act, 2013
• Companies (Share Capital and Debentures) Rules, 2014.
• National Company Law Tribunal Rules, 2016
2. Reduction of Share Capital
– Legal Provisions
• Section 66 of the Companies Act, 2013
• Rule 2 to 6 of the National Company Law Tribunal (Procedure for Reduction of Share Capital of
Company) Rules, 2016
• SEBI (LODR) Regulations, 2015.
3. Buy-Back
– Legal Provisions
• Companies Act, 2013
• Companies (Share Capital and Debentures) Rules, 2014.
• Securities and Exchange Board of India (Buy-back of Securities) Regulations, 2018.
Disclosures to the Tribunal – The company or any other person, by whom an application is made under sub-
section (1), shall disclose to the Tribunal by affidavit –
(a) all material facts relating to the company, such as the latest financial position of the company, the latest
auditor’s report on the accounts of the company and the pendency of any investigation or proceedings
against the company;
(b) reduction of share capital of the company, if any, included in the compromise or arrangement;
84 PP-IL&P
(c) any scheme of corporate debt restructuring consented to by not less than seventy-five per cent. of the
secured creditors in value, including –
(i) a creditor’s responsibility statement in the prescribed form;
(ii) safeguards for the protection of other secured and unsecured creditors;
(iii) report by the auditor that the fund requirements of the company after the corporate debt
restructuring as approved shall conform to the liquidity test based upon the estimates provided to
them by the Board;
(iv) where the company proposes to adopt the corporate debt restructuring guidelines specified by the
Reserve Bank of India, a statement to that effect; and
(v) a valuation report in respect of the shares and the property and all assets, tangible and intangible,
movable and immovable, of the company by a registered valuer. [Section 230(2)]
Notice of the meeting – Where a meeting is proposed to be called in pursuance of an order of the Tribunal
under sub-section (1), a notice of such meeting shall be sent to all the creditors or class of creditors and to all the
members or class of members and the debenture-holders of the company, individually at the address registered
with the company which shall be accompanied by a statement disclosing the details of the compromise or
arrangement, a copy of the valuation report, if any, and explaining their effect on creditors, key managerial
personnel, promoters and non-promoter members, and the debenture-holders and the effect of the compromise
or arrangement on any material interests of the directors of the company or the debenture trustees, and such
other matters as may be prescribed:
Provided that such notice and other documents shall also be placed on the website of the company, if any,
and in case of a listed company, these documents shall be sent to the Securities and Exchange Board and
stock exchange where the securities of the companies are listed, for placing on their website and shall also be
published in newspapers in such manner as may be prescribed:
Provided further that where the notice for the meeting is also issued by way of an advertisement, it shall indicate
the time within which copies of the compromise or arrangement shall be made available to the concerned
persons free of charge from the registered office of the company. [Section 230(3)]
Voting by themselves or through proxy or through postal ballot – A notice under sub-section (3) shall
provide that the persons to whom the notice is sent may vote in the meeting either themselves or through
proxies or by postal ballot to the adoption of the compromise or arrangement within one month from the date
of receipt of such notice:
Provided that any objection to the compromise or arrangement shall be made only by persons holding not less
than ten per cent. of the shareholding or having outstanding debt amounting to not less than five per cent. of the
total outstanding debt as per the latest audited financial statement. [Section 230(4)]
Lesson 5 n Resolution Strategies 85
Notice to be sent to the regulators seeking their representations – A notice under sub-section (3) along with
all the documents in such form as may be prescribed shall also be sent to the Central Government, the income-
tax authorities, the Reserve Bank of India, the Securities and Exchange Board, the Registrar, the respective
stock exchanges, the Official Liquidator, the Competition Commission of India established under sub-section (1)
of section 7 of the Competition Act, 2002, if necessary, and such other sectoral regulators or authorities which
are likely to be affected by the compromise or arrangement and shall require that representations, if any, to be
made by them shall be made within a period of thirty days from the date of receipt of such notice, failing which,
it shall be presumed that they have no representations to make on the proposals. [Section 230(5)]
Binding nature of compromise or arrangement – Where, at a meeting held in pursuance of sub-section (1),
majority of persons representing three-fourths in value of the creditors, or class of creditors or members or class
of members, as the case may be, voting in person or by proxy or by postal ballot, agree to any compromise
or arrangement and if such compromise or arrangement is sanctioned by the Tribunal by an order, the same
shall be binding on the company, all the creditors, or class of creditors or members or class of members, as the
case may be, or, in case of a company being wound up, on the liquidator appointed under this Act or under the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, as the case may be, and the contributories of the company. [Section
230(6)]
Order of the tribunal to provide for the certain matters – An order made by the Tribunal under sub-section
(6) shall provide for all or any of the following matters, namely: –
(a) where the compromise or arrangement provides for conversion of preference shares into equity shares,
such preference shareholders shall be given an option to either obtain arrears of dividend in cash or
accept equity shares equal to the value of the dividend payable;
(b) the protection of any class of creditors;
(c) if the compromise or arrangement results in the variation of the shareholders’ rights, it shall be given
effect to under the provisions of section 48;
(d) if the compromise or arrangement is agreed to by the creditors under sub-section (6), any proceedings
pending before the Board for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction established under section 4 of the
Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 shall abate;
(e) such other matters including exit offer to dissenting shareholders, if any, as are in the opinion of the
Tribunal necessary to effectively implement the terms of the compromise or arrangement:
86 PP-IL&P
Provided that no compromise or arrangement shall be sanctioned by the Tribunal unless a certificate by the
company’s auditor has been filed with the Tribunal to the effect that the accounting treatment, if any, proposed
in the scheme of compromise or arrangement is in conformity with the accounting standards prescribed under
section 133. [Section 230(7)]
Filing of order – The order of the Tribunal shall be filed with the Registrar by the company within a period of
thirty days of the receipt of the order. [Section 230(8)]
Meeting of creditors – The Tribunal may dispense with calling of a meeting of creditor or class of creditors
where such creditors or class of creditors, having at least ninety per cent. value, agree and confirm, by way of
affidavit, to the scheme of compromise or arrangement. [Section 230(9)]
Compromise or arrangement in respect of buy-back – No compromise or arrangement in respect of any buy-
back of securities under this section shall be sanctioned by the Tribunal unless such buy-back is in accordance
with the provisions of section 68.] [Section 230(10)]
Takeover offer – Any compromise or arrangement may include takeover offer made in such manner as may
be prescribed:
Provided that in case of listed companies, takeover offer shall be as per the regulations framed by the Securities
and Exchange Board. [Section 230(11)]
Application to Tribunal by aggrieved party – An aggrieved party may make an application to the Tribunal
in the event of any grievances with respect to the takeover offer of companies other than listed companies in
such manner as may be prescribed and the Tribunal may, on application, pass such order as it may deem fit.
[Section 230(12)]
Explanation. – For the removal of doubts, it is hereby declared that the provisions of section 66 shall not apply
to the reduction of share capital effected in pursuance of the order of the Tribunal under this section.
implemented satisfactorily with or without modifications, and the company is unable to pay its debts as per the
scheme, it may make an order for winding up the company and such an order shall be deemed to be an order
made under section 273. [Section 231(2)]
The provisions of this section shall, so far as may be, also apply to a company in respect of which an order
has been made before the commencement of this Act sanctioning a compromise or an arrangement. [Section
231(3)]
like instruments in the company which, under the compromise or arrangement, are to be allotted or
appropriated by that company to or for any person:
Provided that a transferee company shall not, as a result of the compromise or arrangement, hold
any shares in its own name or in the name of any trust whether on its behalf or on behalf of any of its
subsidiary or associate companies and any such shares shall be cancelled or extinguished;
(c) the continuation by or against the transferee company of any legal proceedings pending by or against
any transferor company on the date of transfer;
(d) dissolution, without winding-up, of any transferor company;
(e) the provision to be made for any persons who, within such time and in such manner as the Tribunal
directs, dissent from the compromise or arrangement;
(f) where share capital is held by any non-resident shareholder under the foreign direct investment norms
or guidelines specified by the Central Government or in accordance with any law for the time being in
force, the allotment of shares of the transferee company to such shareholder shall be in the manner
specified in the order;
(g) the transfer of the employees of the transferor company to the transferee company;
(h) where the transferor company is a listed company and the transferee company is an unlisted company, –
(A) the transferee company shall remain an unlisted company until it becomes a listed company;
(B) if shareholders of the transferor company decide to opt out of the transferee company, provision
shall be made for payment of the value of shares held by them and other benefits in accordance
with a pre-determined price formula or after a valuation is made, and the arrangements under this
provision may be made by the Tribunal:
Provided that the amount of payment or valuation under this clause for any share shall not be less
than what has been specified by the Securities and Exchange Board under any regulations framed
by it;
(i) where the transferor company is dissolved, the fee, if any, paid by the transferor company on its
authorised capital shall be set-off against any fees payable by the transferee company on its authorised
capital subsequent to the amalgamation; and
(j) such incidental, consequential and supplemental matters as are deemed necessary to secure that the
merger or amalgamation is fully and effectively carried out:
Provided that no compromise or arrangement shall be sanctioned by the Tribunal unless a certificate by
the company’s auditor has been filed with the Tribunal to the effect that the accounting treatment, if any,
proposed in the scheme of compromise or arrangement is in conformity with the accounting standards
prescribed under section 133. [Section 232(3)]
Where an order under this section provides for the transfer of any property or liabilities, then, by virtue of the
order, that property shall be transferred to the transferee company and the liabilities shall be transferred to and
become the liabilities of the transferee company and any property may, if the order so directs, be freed from any
charge which shall by virtue of the compromise or arrangement, cease to have effect. [Section 232(4)]
Lesson 5 n Resolution Strategies 89
Every company in relation to which the order is made shall cause a certified copy of the order to be filed with the
Registrar for registration within thirty days of the receipt of certified copy of the order. [Section 232(5)]
The scheme under this section shall clearly indicate an appointed date from which it shall be effective and the
scheme shall be deemed to be effective from such date and not at a date subsequent to the appointed date.
[Section 232(6)]
Every company in relation to which the order is made shall, until the completion of the scheme, file a statement
in such form and within such time as may be prescribed with the Registrar every year duly certified by a
chartered accountant or a cost accountant or a company secretary in practice indicating whether the scheme is
being complied with in accordance with the orders of the Tribunal or not. [Section 232(7)]
If a transferor company or a transferee company contravenes the provisions of this section, the transferor
company or the transferee company, as the case may be, shall be punishable with fine which shall not be less
than one lakh rupees but which may extend to twenty-five lakh rupees and every officer of such transferor or
transferee company who is in default, shall be punishable with imprisonment for a term which may extend to
one year or with fine which shall not be less than one lakh rupees but which may extend to three lakh rupees,
or with both.
Explanation. – For the purposes of this section, –
(i) in a scheme involving a merger, where under the scheme the undertaking, property and liabilities of
one or more companies, including the company in respect of which the compromise or arrangement
is proposed, are to be transferred to another existing company, it is a merger by absorption, or where
the undertaking, property and liabilities of two or more companies, including the company in respect of
which the compromise or arrangement is proposed, are to be transferred to a new company, whether
or not a public company, it is a merger by formation of a new company;
(ii) references to merging companies are in relation to a merger by absorption, to the transferor and
transferee companies, and, in relation to a merger by formation of a new company, to the transferor
companies;
(iii) a scheme involves a division, where under the scheme the undertaking, property and liabilities of the
company in respect of which the compromise or arrangement is proposed are to be divided among and
transferred to two or more companies each of which is either an existing company or a new company; and
(iv) property includes assets, rights and interests of every description and liabilities include debts and
obligations of every description. [Section 232(8)]
(a) a notice of the proposed scheme inviting objections or suggestions, if any, from the Registrar and
Official Liquidators where registered office of the respective companies are situated or persons affected
by the scheme within thirty days is issued by the transferor company or companies and the transferee
company;
(b) the objections and suggestions received are considered by the companies in their respective general
meetings and the scheme is approved by the respective members or class of members at a general
meeting holding at least ninety per cent. of the total number of shares;
(c) each of the companies involved in the merger files a declaration of solvency, in the prescribed form,
with the Registrar of the place where the registered office of the company is situated; and
(d) the scheme is approved by majority representing nine-tenths in value of the creditors or class of creditors
of respective companies indicated in a meeting convened by the company by giving a notice of twenty-
one days along with the scheme to its creditors for the purpose or otherwise approved in writing.
(2) The transferee company shall file a copy of the scheme so approved in the manner as may be prescribed,
with the Central Government, Registrar and the Official Liquidator where the registered office of the company
is situated.
(3) On the receipt of the scheme, if the Registrar or the Official Liquidator has no objections or suggestions to
the scheme, the Central Government shall register the same and issue a confirmation thereof to the companies.
(4) If the Registrar or Official Liquidator has any objections or suggestions, he may communicate the same in
writing to the Central Government within a period of thirty days:
Provided that if no such communication is made, it shall be presumed that he has no objection to the scheme.
(5) If the Central Government after receiving the objections or suggestions or for any reason is of the opinion
that such a scheme is not in public interest or in the interest of the creditors, it may file an application before the
Tribunal within a period of sixty days of the receipt of the scheme under sub-section (2) stating its objections
and requesting that the Tribunal may consider the scheme under section 232.
(6) On receipt of an application from the Central Government or from any person, if the Tribunal, for reasons to
be recorded in writing, is of the opinion that the scheme should be considered as per the procedure laid down
in section 232, the Tribunal may direct accordingly or it may confirm the scheme by passing such order as it
deems fit:
Provided that if the Central Government does not have any objection to the scheme or it does not file any
application under this section before the Tribunal, it shall be deemed that it has no objection to the scheme.
(7) A copy of the order under sub-section (6) confirming the scheme shall be communicated to the Registrar
having jurisdiction over the transferee company and the persons concerned and the Registrar shall register the
scheme and issue a confirmation thereof to the companies and such confirmation shall be communicated to the
Registrars where transferor company or companies were situated.
(8) The registration of the scheme under sub-section (3) or sub-section (7) shall be deemed to have the effect
of dissolution of the transferor company without process of winding-up.
(9) The registration of the scheme shall have the following effects, namely: –
(a) transfer of property or liabilities of the transferor company to the transferee company so that the
property becomes the property of the transferee company and the liabilities become the liabilities of the
transferee company;
(b) the charges, if any, on the property of the transferor company shall be applicable and enforceable as if
the charges were on the property of the transferee company;
Lesson 5 n Resolution Strategies 91
(c) legal proceedings by or against the transferor company pending before any court of law shall be
continued by or against the transferee company; and
(d) where the scheme provides for purchase of shares held by the dissenting shareholders or settlement
of debt due to dissenting creditors, such amount, to the extent it is unpaid, shall become the liability of
the transferee company.
(10) A transferee company shall not on merger or amalgamation, hold any shares in its own name or in the
name of any trust either on its behalf or on behalf of any of its subsidiary or associate company and all such
shares shall be cancelled or extinguished on the merger or amalgamation.
(11) The transferee company shall file an application with the Registrar along with the scheme registered,
indicating the revised authorised capital and pay the prescribed fees due on revised capital:
Provided that the fee, if any, paid by the transferor company on its authorised capital prior to its merger or
amalgamation with the transferee company shall be set-off against the fees payable by the transferee company
on its authorised capital enhanced by the merger or amalgamation.
(12) The provisions of this section shall mutatis mutandis apply to a company or companies specified in sub-
section (1) in respect of a scheme of compromise or arrangement referred to in section 230 or division or
transfer of a company referred to clause (b) of sub-section (1) of section 232.
(13) The Central Government may provide for the merger or amalgamation of companies in such manner as
may be prescribed.
(14) A company covered under this section may use the provisions of section 232 for the approval of any
scheme for merger or amalgamation.
time within two months after the expiry of the said four months, give notice in the prescribed manner to any
dissenting shareholder that it desires to acquire his shares.
(2) Where a notice under sub-section (1) is given, the transferee company shall, unless on an application made
by the dissenting shareholder to the Tribunal, within one month from the date on which the notice was given
and the Tribunal thinks fit to order otherwise, be entitled to and bound to acquire those shares on the terms
on which, under the scheme or contract, the shares of the approving shareholders are to be transferred to the
transferee company.
(3) Where a notice has been given by the transferee company under sub-section (1) and the Tribunal has not,
on an application made by the dissenting shareholder, made an order to the contrary, the transferee company
shall, on the expiry of one month from the date on which the notice has been given, or, if an application to the
Tribunal by the dissenting shareholder is then pending, after that application has been disposed of, send a
copy of the notice to the transferor company together with an instrument of transfer, to be executed on behalf
of the shareholder by any person appointed by the transferor company and on its own behalf by the transferee
company, and pay or transfer to the transferor company the amount or other consideration representing the
price payable by the transferee company for the shares which, by virtue of this section, that company is entitled
to acquire, and the transferor company shall –
(a) thereupon register the transferee company as the holder of those shares; and
(b) within one month of the date of such registration, inform the dissenting shareholders of the fact of such
registration and of the receipt of the amount or other consideration representing the price payable to
them by the transferee company.
(4) Any sum received by the transferor company under this section shall be paid into a separate bank account,
and any such sum and any other consideration so received shall be held by that company in trust for the
several persons entitled to the shares in respect of which the said sum or other consideration were respectively
received and shall be disbursed to the entitled shareholders within sixty days.
(5) In relation to an offer made by a transferee company to shareholders of a transferor company before the
commencement of this Act, this section shall have effect with the following modifications, namely: –
(a) in sub-section (1), for the words “the shares whose transfer is involved other than shares already held at
the date of the offer by, or by a nominee of, the transferee company or its subsidiaries,”, the words “the shares
affected” shall be substituted; and
(b) in sub-section (3), the words “together with an instrument of transfer, to be executed on behalf of the
shareholder by any person appointed by the transferee company and on its own behalf by the transferor
company” shall be omitted.
Explanation. – For the purposes of this section, “dissenting shareholder” includes a shareholder who has not
assented to the scheme or contract and any shareholder who has failed or refused to transfer his shares to the
transferee company in accordance with the scheme or contract.
Lesson 5 n Resolution Strategies 93
When a shareholder or the majority equity shareholder fails to acquire full purchase of the shares of the minority
equity shareholders, then, the provisions of this section shall continue to apply to the residual minority equity
shareholders, even though, –
(a) the shares of the company of the residual minority equity shareholder had been delisted; and
(b) the period of one year or the period specified in the regulations made by the Securities and Exchange Board
under the Securities and Exchange Board of India Act, 1992, had elapsed. [Section 236(9)]
(2) An appeal shall lie to the Tribunal against an order of the Registrar refusing to register any circular under
sub-section (1).
(3) The director who issues a circular which has not been presented for registration and registered under clause
(c) of sub-section (1), shall be punishable with fine which shall not be less than twenty-five thousand rupees but
which may extend to five lakh rupees.
(2) In cases not covered under sub-regulation (1), the liquidator shall within seven days of the liquidation
commencement date, appoint two registered valuers to determine the realisable value of the assets or
businesses under clauses (a) to (f) of regulation 32 of the corporate debtor:
Provided that the following persons shall not be appointed as registered valuers, namely:
(a) a relative of the liquidator;
(b) a related party of the corporate debtor;
(c) an auditor of the corporate debtor at any time during the five years preceding the insolvency
commencement date; or
(d) a partner or director of the insolvency professional entity of which the liquidator is a partner or director.
(3) The Registered Valuers appointed under sub-regulation (2) shall independently submit to the liquidator the
estimates of realisable value of the assets or businesses, as the case may be, computed in accordance with
the Companies (Registered Valuers and Valuation) Rules, 2017, after physical verification of the assets of the
corporate debtor.
(4) The average of two estimates received under sub-regulation (3) shall be taken as the value of the assets or
businesses.
Valuation under the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code – Valuation is required to be made in respect of any
property, stocks, shares, debentures, securities or goodwill etc under the provisions of the Companies Act,
2013. Similarly, valuation is also required under the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
According to regulation 2(h) of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India (Liquidation Process) Regulations,
2016, “registered valuer” means a person registered as such in accordance with the Companies Act, 2013 and
rules made thereunder.
Thus, a valuer registered under the Companies Act can also undertake valuation under the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
(3) Where the liquidator informs the secured creditor of a person willing to buy the secured asset under sub-
regulation (2), the secured creditor shall sell the asset to such person.
(4) If the liquidator does not inform the secured creditor in accordance with sub-regulation (2), or the person
does not buy the secured asset in accordance with sub-regulation (2), the secured creditor may realize the
secured asset in the manner it deems fit, but at least at the price intimated under sub-regulation (1).
(5) Where the secured asset is realized under sub-regulation (3), the secured creditor shall bear the cost of
identification of the buyer under sub-regulation (2).
(6) Where the secured asset is realized under sub-regulation (4), the liquidator shall bear the cost of incurred to
identify the buyer under sub-regulation (2).
(7) The provisions of this Regulation shall not apply if the secured creditor enforces his security interest under
the Securitization and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002 or the
Recovery of Debts and Bankruptcy Act, 1993.
Introduction
Corporate failure may be due to business or financial failure. Business failure is breaking down of business
model and inability to generate enough revenues. Financial failure is due to mismatch between payments and
receivables of an enterprise. A sound bankruptcy process helps the creditors and debtors to come to a platform
that brings remedy for business or financial failure. It is not necessary that the defaulting companies go for
liquidation. There may be situations in which a viable mechanism can be found through which the companies
may be protected as a going concern.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code is a new generation law that provides efficient revival mechanism and
also throws challenges in the form of capacity building, harmonisation of various laws, creation of insolvency
professionals, development of regulatory platform and so on.
The aim of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy code is to conclude the procedure within half of the default time
period specified under the Code. The person or entity seeking the fast relief will have onus on the process
at set-off and that person or entity that sets-off the Fast-track process must support that the case is fit for the
Fast-track. Therefore, whosoever fills the application for fast track process under Chapter IV (Section 55) of the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code will have to file the application along with the proof of the existence of default
as evidenced by records available with an information utility or such other means as may be specified by the
Board to establish that the corporate debtor is eligible for fast track corporate insolvency resolution process.
Time period for completion of fast track corporate insolvency resolution process
Section 56(1) provides that subject to the provisions of sub-section (3), the fast track corporate insolvency
resolution process shall be completed within a period of ninety days from the insolvency commencement date.
101
102 PP-IL&P
Section 56(2) states that the resolution professional shall file an application to the Adjudicating Authority to
extend the period of the fast track corporate insolvency resolution process beyond ninety days if instructed to do
so by way of a resolution passed at a meeting of the committee of creditors and supported by a vote of seventy-
five per cent. of the voting share.
As per Section 56(3) on receipt of an application under sub-section (2), if the Adjudicating Authority is satisfied
that the subject matter of the case is such that fast track corporate insolvency resolution process cannot
be completed within ninety days, it may, by order, extend the duration of such process beyond the said period
ninety days by such further period, as it thinks fit, but not exceeding forty-five days.
It may be noted that any extension of the fast track corporate insolvency resolution process under this section
shall not be granted more than once.
Important Definitions
“Applicant” means the person filing an application under Chapter IV of Part II of the Code;
“Code of Conduct” means the code of conduct for insolvency professionals as set out in the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Board of India (Insolvency Professionals) Regulations, 2016.
“Committee” means a committee of creditors established under section 21.
“Dissenting Financial Creditor” means a financial creditor who voted against the resolution plan or abstained
from voting for the resolution plan, approved by the committee.
“Electronic Form” shall have the meaning assigned to it in the Information Technology Act, 2000.
“Electronic Means” means an authorized and secured computer programme which is capable of producing
confirmation of sending communication to the participant entitled to receive such communication at the last
electronic mail address provided by such participant and keeping record of such communication.
“Evaluation Matrix” means such parameters to be applied and the manner of applying such parameters, as
approved by the committee, for consideration of resolution plans for its approval.
“Fair Value” means the estimated realizable value of the assets of the corporate debtor, if they were to be
exchanged on the insolvency commencement date between a willing buyer and a willing seller in an arm’s
length transaction, after proper marketing and where the parties had acted knowledgeably, prudently and
without compulsion.
“Fast Track Process” means the fast track insolvency resolution process for corporate persons under Chapter
IV of Part II of the Code.
“Fast Track Process Costs” means the costs in Regulation 30.
Lesson 6 n Fast Track Corporation Insolvency Resolution Process 103
“Fast Track Process Period” means the period of ninety days beginning from the fast track recommencement
date and ending on the ninetieth day;
“Identification Number” means the Limited Liability Partnership Identification Number under the Limited
Liability Partnership Act, 2008, or the Corporate Identity Number under the Companies Act, 2013, as the case
may be.
“Fast Track Commencement Date” means the date of admission of an application by the Adjudicating
Authority for initiating the fast track process under Chapter IV of Part II of the Code.
“Insolvency Professional Entity” means an entity recognised as such under the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Board of India (Insolvency Professionals) Regulations, 2016.
“Liquidation Value” means the estimated realizable value of the assets of the corporate debtor, if the corporate
debtor were to be liquidated on the insolvency commencement date.
“Participant” means a person entitled to attend a meeting of the committee under section 24 or any other
person authorised by the committee to attend the meeting.
“Registered Valuer” means a person registered as such in accordance with the Companies Act, 2013 and
rules made thereunder;
“Video Conferencing or other audio and visual means” means such audio and visual facility which enables
the participants in a meeting to communicate concurrently with one another and to participate effectively in the
meeting.
Eligibility for Resolution Professional (Regulation 3)
(1) An insolvency professional shall be eligible to be appointed as a resolution professional for a fast track
process of a corporate debtor if he, and all partners and directors of the insolvency professional entity
of which he is a partner or director are independent of the corporate debtor.
Explanation– A person shall be considered independent of the corporate debtor, if he –
(a) is eligible to be appointed as an independent director on the board of the corporate debtor under
section 149 of the Companies Act, 2013 (18 of 2013), where the corporate debtor is a company;
(b) is not a related party of the corporate debtor; or
(c) has not been an employee or proprietor or a partner:
1) of a firm of auditors or company secretaries in practice or cost auditors of the corporate
debtor; or
2) of a legal or a consulting firm, which has or had any transaction with the corporate debtor
amounting to ten per cent or more of the gross turnover of such firm,
at any time in the preceding three years.
(2) An insolvency professional shall not be eligible to be appointed as a resolution professional if he, or the
insolvency professional entity of which he is a partner or director, is under a restraint order of the Board.
(3) An insolvency professional shall make disclosures at the time of his appointment and thereafter in
accordance with the Code of Conduct.
(4) An insolvency professional shall not continue as a resolution professional if the insolvency professional
entity of which he is a director or a partner, or any other partner or director of such insolvency professional
entity represents any other stakeholders in the same fast track process.
104 PP-IL&P
(2) The existence of debt due to the operational creditor under this Regulation may be proved on the basis
of-
(a) the records available with an information utility, if any; or
(b) other relevant documents, including -
(i) a contract for the supply of goods and services with corporate debtor;
(ii) an invoice demanding payment for the goods and services supplied to the corporate debtor;
(iii) an order of a court or tribunal that has adjudicated upon the non-payment of a debt, if any;
or
(iv) financial accounts.
(iii) an order of a court or tribunal that has adjudicated upon the non-payment of a dues, if any.
(2) Based on records of the corporate debtor and claims, if the interim resolution professional is of the
opinion that the fast track process is not applicable to the corporate debtor as per notifications under
section 55(2), he shall file an application to the Adjudicating Authority along with the report in sub-
regulation (1), to pass an order converting the fast track process to corporate insolvency resolution
process under Chapter II of Part II of the Code.
(3) If the Adjudicating Authority passes an order converting fast track to corporate insolvency resolution
process on an application under sub-regulation (2), the process shall be carried on in accordance with
the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India (Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate Persons)
Regulations, 2016.
(4) The interim resolution professional shall convene the first meeting of the committee within seven days
of filing the report(s) under this Regulation.
(7) If a creditor, other than a member of the committee, fails to provide or update the relevant e-mail
address to the resolution professional, the non-receipt of such notice by such participant of any meeting
shall not invalidate the decisions taken at such meeting.
(3) The resolution professional shall take due and reasonable care-
(a) to safeguard the integrity of the meeting by ensuring sufficient security and identification
procedures;
(b) to ensure availability of proper video conferencing or other audio and visual equipment or facilities
for providing transmission of the communications for effective participation of the participants at
the meeting;
(c) to record proceedings and prepare the minutes of the meeting;
(d) to store for safekeeping and marking the physical recording(s) or other electronic recording
mechanism as part of the records of the corporate debtor;
(e) to ensure that no person other than the intended participants attends or has access to the
proceedings of the meeting through video conferencing or other audio and visual means; and
(f) to ensure that participants attending the meeting through audio and visual means are able to hear
and see, if applicable, the other participants clearly during the course of the meeting:
Provided that the persons, who are differently abled, may make request to the resolution
professional to allow a person to accompany him at the meeting.
(4) Where a meeting is conducted through video conferencing or other audio and visual means, the
scheduled venue of the meeting as set forth in the notice convening the meeting, which shall be in
India, shall be deemed to be the place of the said meeting and all recordings of the proceedings
at the meeting shall be deemed to be made at such place.
committee and such minutes shall disclose the particulars of the participants who attended the meeting
in person, through video conferencing, or other audio and visual means.
(7) The resolution professional shall circulate the minutes of the meeting to all participants by electronic
means within forty-eight hours of the said meeting.
(g) expenses incurred on or by the interim resolution professional to the extent ratified under Regulation
32;
(h) expenses incurred on or by the resolution professional fixed under Regulation 33; and
(i) other costs directly relating to the fast track process and approved by the committee.
an undue gain or undue loss to itself or any other person and comply with the requirements under sub-
section (2) of the section 29.
(3) The resolution professional and registered valuer shall maintain the confidentiality of the fair value and
the liquidation value.
Sections 33 to 54 in Chapter III of Part II of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 lays down the law
relating to liquidation process for corporate persons.
An attempt is first made to resolve the insolvency of corporate debtor through corporate insolvency resolution
process laid down in Chapter II of Part II of the Code. The provisions relating to liquidation in Chapter III of Part
II of the Code comes into effect if the attempts to resolve corporate insolvency under Chapter II of the Code fail.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has made the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India
(Liquidation Process) Regulations, 2016 to regulate the liquidation process under Chapter III of Part II
of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016. These regulations are amended from time to time by the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
Initiation of Liquidation
Section 33 of the Code lists out the triggers for initiating the liquidation process for corporate persons. Section
33 of the Code reads as follows:
“(1) Where the Adjudicating Authority,
(a) before the expiry of the insolvency resolution process period or the maximum period permitted for
completion of the corporate insolvency resolution process under section 12 or the fast track corporate
insolvency resolution process under section 56, as the case may be, does not receive a resolution plan
under sub-section (6) of section 30; or
(b) rejects the resolution plan under section 31 for the non-compliance of the requirements specified
therein, it shall –
(i) pass an order requiring the corporate debtor to be liquidated in the manner as laid down in this
Chapter;
(ii) issue a public announcement stating that the corporate debtor is in liquidation; and
(iii) require such order to be sent to the authority with which the corporate debtor is registered.
(2) Where the resolution professional, at any time during the corporate insolvency resolution process but
before confirmation of resolution plan, intimates the Adjudicating Authority of the decision of the committee
of creditors approved by not less than sixty-six per cent. of the voting share to liquidate the corporate debtor,
the Adjudicating Authority shall pass a liquidation order as referred to in sub-clauses (i), (ii) and (iii) of clause
(b) of sub-section (1).
(3) Where the resolution plan approved by the Adjudicating Authority is contravened by the concerned
corporate debtor, any person other than the corporate debtor, whose interests are prejudicially affected by
such contravention, may make an application to the Adjudicating Authority for a liquidation order as referred
to in sub-clauses (i), (ii), (iii) of clause (b) sub-section (1).
(4) On receipt of an application under sub-section (3), if the Adjudicating Authority determines that the
119
120 PP-IL&P
corporate debtor has contravened the provisions of the resolution plan, it shall pass a liquidation order as
referred to in sub-clauses (i), (ii) and (iii) of clause (b) of sub-section (1).
(5) Subject to section 52, when a liquidation order has been passed, no suit or other legal proceeding shall
be instituted by or against the corporate debtor:
Provided that a suit or other legal proceeding may be instituted by the liquidator, on behalf of the corporate
debtor, with the prior approval of the Adjudicating Authority,
(6) the provisions of sub-section (5) shall not apply to legal proceedings in relation to such transactions as
may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial sector regulator.
(7) The order for liquidation under this section shall be deemed to be a notice of discharge to the officers,
employees and workmen of the corporate debtor, except when the business of the corporate debtor is
continued during the liquidation process by the liquidator.”
When liquidation can be ordered – Section 33 provides for the liquidation of the corporate debtor in following
four scenarios:
1. Where the Adjudicating Authority does not receive a resolution plan
2. Where the Adjudicating Authority rejects the resolution plan
3. Where, at any time before confirmation of resolution plan, the committee of creditors resolve to liquidate
corporate debtor
4. Where the corporate debtor violates the terms of the resolution plan
1. Where the Adjudicating Authority does not receive a resolution plan – If the Adjudicating Authority,
before the expiry of the insolvency resolution process period or the maximum period permitted for completion of
the corporate insolvency resolution process under section 12 or the fast track corporate insolvency resolution
process under section 56, as the case may be, does not receive a resolution plan under sub-section (6) of
section 30, it shall pass an order requiring the corporate debtor to be liquidated in the manner as laid down in
Chapter III of Part II of the Code. [Section 33(1)]
In the matter of Vedikat Nut Crafts Pvt. Ltd, After perusing records, the AA could not see any reason for not
inviting resolution plan despite the fact that even a period of one month as balance period of 180 days wasstill
available. NCLT observed that there was no reason for the Committee of Creditors to jump to the conclusion of
seeking liquidation of the company without seeking extension of time of 90 days, without inviting expression of
interest by the prospective resolution plan applicant as it falls foul of legal provisions and fair play. It presents a
tell tale story of the irregularity committed by the CoC. To say the least such a decision is arbitrary and should
not be sustained.
2. Where the Adjudicating Authority rejects the resolution plan – If the Adjudicating Authority rejects the
resolution plan under section 31 for the non-compliance of the requirements specified therein, it shall pass an
order requiring the corporate debtor to be liquidated in the manner as laid down in Chapter III of Part II of the
Code.
In both the scenarios above i.e., where the Adjudicating Authority does not receive a resolution plan or where
the Adjudicating Authority rejects the resolution plan, it shall:
(i) issue a public announcement stating that the corporate debtor is in liquidation; and
(ii) require such order to be sent to the authority with which the corporate debtor is registered. [Section
33(1)]
3. Where, at any time before confirmation of resolution plan, the committee of creditors resolve to
liquidate corporate debtor – Where the resolution professional, at any time during the corporate insolvency
Lesson 7 n Liquidation of Corporate Person 121
resolution process but before confirmation of resolution plan, intimates the Adjudicating Authority of the decision
of the committee of creditors approved by not less than sixty-six percent of the voting share to liquidate the
corporate debtor, the Adjudicating Authority shall pass a liquidation order as referred to in sub-clauses (i), (ii)
and (iii) of clause (b) of sub-section (1). [Section 33(2)]
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has amended sub-section (2) of
section 33 to provide for a reduced threshold from seventy-five percent to sixty-six percent of voting share
for obtaining the approval of the committee of creditors for making an application to the Adjudicating Authority
to pass a liquidation order.
4. Where the corporate debtor violates the terms of the resolution plan – Where the resolution plan
approved by the Adjudicating Authority is contravened by the concerned corporate debtor, any person other
than the corporate debtor, whose interests are prejudicially affected by such contravention, may make an
application to the Adjudicating Authority for a liquidation order as referred to in sub-clauses (i), (ii), (iii) of clause
(b) sub-section (1). [Section 33(3)]
On receipt of an application under sub-section (3), if the Adjudicating Authority determines that the corporate
debtor has contravened the provisions of the resolution plan, it shall pass a liquidation order as referred to in
sub-clauses (i), (ii) and (iii) of clause (b) of sub-section (1). [Section 33(4)]
Case Law:
In the case of Sunrise Polyfilms Pvt Ltd. Vs. Punjab National Bank, the RP filed an application praying for an
order of liquidation. NCLT noted that the RP did not invite application for resolution plan and straight away
decided to go for liquidation. NCLT observed that it is clear that the resolution professional has neither performed
his statutory duties and responsibilities nor the COC seems to have shown much interest and made efforts to
achieve the object of the Code for exploring the possibilities for revival of the company. NCLT directed the RP to
invite and consider plans of resolution applicants, if any, and take the same to CoC as per mandate of the Code.
Bar to filing of suits and legal proceedings – Section 33(5) provides that subject to section 52, when
a liquidation order has been passed, no suit or other legal proceeding shall be instituted by or against the
corporate debtor:
Provided that a suit or other legal proceeding may be instituted by the liquidator, on behalf of the corporate
debtor, with the prior approval of the Adjudicating Authority,
Section 33(6) further provides that the provisions of sub-section (5) shall not apply to legal proceedings in
relation to such transactions as may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial
sector regulator.
“Financial Sector Regulator” means an authority or body constituted under any law for the time being in
force to regulate services or transactions of financial sector and includes the Reserve Bank of India, the
Securities and Exchange Board of India, the Insurance Regulatory and Development Authority of India, the
Pension Fund Regulatory Authority and such other regulatory authorities as may be notified by the Central
Government. [Section 3(18)]
Liquidation order to be deemed to be a notice of discharge – The order for liquidation under section 33
shall be deemed to be a notice of discharge to the officers, employees and workmen of the corporate debtor,
except when the business of the corporate debtor is continued during the liquidation process by the liquidator.
[Section 33(7)]
According to section 5(18) of the Code, a “liquidator” means an insolvency professional appointed as a
liquidator in accordance with the provisions of Chapter III or Chapter V of this Part, as the case may be.
Resolution Professional to act as liquidator – Section 34(1) provides that where the Adjudicating Authority
passes an order for liquidation of the corporate debtor under section 33, the resolution professional appointed
for the corporate insolvency resolution process under Chapter II shall, subject to submission of a written consent
by the resolution professional to the Adjudicatory Authority in specified form, shall act as the liquidator for the
purposes of liquidation unless replaced by the Adjudicating Authority under subsection (4).
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has amended section 34 so as to
require a written consent of resolution professional in specified form for appointment as a liquidator.
Powers to vest in liquidator – Section 34(2) further provides that on the appointment of a liquidator under
section 34, all powers of the board of directors, key managerial personnel and the partners of the corporate
debtor, as the case may be, shall cease to have effect and shall be vested in the liquidator.
Personnel of corporate debtor to extend all assistance and cooperation to the liquidator – Section
34(3) mandates that the personnel of the corporate debtor shall extend all assistance and cooperation to the
liquidator as may be required by him in managing the affairs of the corporate debtor and provisions of section
19 shall apply in relation to voluntary liquidation process as they apply in relation to liquidation process with the
substitution of references to the liquidator for references to the interim resolution professional.
Replacement of resolution professional – Sub-section (4) of section 34 makes provision for the replacement
of resolution professional. According to sub-section (4), the Adjudicating Authority shall by order replace the
resolution professional, if
(a) the resolution plan submitted by the resolution professional under section 30 was rejected for failure to
meet the requirements mentioned in sub-section (2) of section 30; or
(b) the Board recommends the replacement of a resolution professional to the Adjudicating Authority for
reasons to be recorded in writing; or
(c) the resolution professional fails to submit written consent under sub-section (1).
For the purposes of clause (a) and clause (c) of sub-section (4), the Adjudicating Authority may direct the Board
to propose the name of another insolvency professional to be appointed as a liquidator. [Section 34(5)]
The Board shall propose the name of another insolvency professional along with written consent from the
insolvency professional in the specified form within ten days of the direction issued by the Adjudicating Authority
under sub-section (5). [Section 34(6)]
The Adjudicating Authority shall, on receipt of the proposal of the Board for the appointment of an insolvency
professional as liquidator, by an order appoint such insolvency professional as the liquidator. [Section 34(7)]
Fee for the conduct of liquidation proceedings – Section 34(8) provides that an insolvency professional
proposed to be appointed as a liquidator shall charge such fee for the conduct of the liquidation proceedings
and in such proportion to the value of the liquidation estate assets, as may be specified by the Board.
The fees for the conduct of the liquidation proceedings under sub-section (8) shall be paid to the liquidator from
the proceeds of the liquidation estate under section 53. [Section 34(9)]
second proviso further provides that the records of any such consultation shall be made available to all other
stakeholders not so consulted, in a manner specified by the Board.
Liquidation Estate
Section 36 provides for the creation of a liquidation estate comprising the assets of the corporate debtor as
set out in section 36(3). Section 36 also lists out the assets which are to be excluded from the liquidation
estate. The Central Government has been given the power to notify assets, in consultation with the appropriate
financial sector regulators, which will be excluded from the estate in the interest of efficient functioning of the
financial markets.
Section 36(1) provides that for the purpose of liquidation, the liquidator shall form an estate of the assets
mentioned in sub-section (3), which will be called the liquidation estate in relation to the corporate debtor.
Section 36(2) further provides that the liquidator shall hold the liquidation estate as a fiduciary for the benefit of
all the creditors.
Liquidation estate shall comprise all liquidation estate assets – Section 36(3) provides that subject to sub-
section (4), the liquidation estate shall comprise all liquidation estate assets which shall include the following:
(a) any assets over which the corporate debtor has ownership rights, including all rights and interests
therein as evidenced in the balance sheet of the corporate debtor or an information utility or records
in the registry or any depository recording securities of the corporate debtor or by any other means as
may be specified by the Board, including shares held in any subsidiary of the corporate debtor;
(b) assets that may or may not be in possession of the corporate debtor including but not limited to
encumbered assets;
(c) tangible assets, whether movable or immovable;
(d) intangible assets including but not limited to intellectual property, securities (including shares held in a
subsidiary of the corporate debtor) and financial instruments, insurance policies, contractual rights;
(e) assets subject to the determination of ownership by the court or authority;
(f) any assets or their value recovered through proceedings for avoidance of transactions in accordance
with this Chapter;
(g) any asset of the corporate debtor in respect of which a secured creditor has relinquished security
interest;
(h) any other property belonging to or vested in the corporate debtor at the insolvency commencement
date; and
(i) all proceeds of liquidation as and when they are realised.
What shall not be included in the liquidation estate assets – According to section 36(4), the following shall
not be included in the liquidation estate assets and shall not be used for recovery in the liquidation:
(a) assets owned by a third party which are in possession of the corporate debtor, including –
(i) assets held in trust for any third party;
(ii) bailment contracts;
(iii) all sums due to any workmen or employee from the provident fund, the pension fund and the
gratuity fund;
(iv) other contractual arrangements which do not stipulate transfer of title but only use of the assets;
and
Lesson 7 n Liquidation of Corporate Person 125
(v) such other assets as may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial
sector regulator;
(b) assets in security collateral held by financial services providers and are subject to netting and set-off in
multi-lateral trading or clearing transactions;
(c) personal assets of any shareholder or partner of a corporate debtor as the case may be provided such
assets are not held on account of avoidance transactions that may be avoided under this Chapter;
(d) assets of any Indian or foreign subsidiary of the corporate debtor; or
(e) any other assets as may be specified by the Board, including assets which could be subject to set-off
on account of mutual dealings between the corporate debtor and any creditor.
The liquidator should not declare the dues in respect to Provident Fund/Pension Fund/Gratuity Fund as part of
the liquidation estate.
In the case of Precision Fasteners Ltd. Vs. Employees Provident Fund Organisation, the liquidator sought a
declaration regarding attachment of movable and immovable properties of the CD (under liquidation) under
Employees’ Provident Funds and Miscellaneous Provisions Act, 1952 as null and void to enable him to dispose
of these properties alongside other assets of the CD. The AA noted that in terms of the Code, the dues in
respect to Provident Fund/Pension Fund/Gratuity Fund are not part of the liquidation estate. The AA vacated
the attachment with a direction to the liquidator to sell the assets and pay off the provident fund dues in priority
to all claims payable by the CD in liquidation.
Consolidation of Claims
Section 38 prescribes a time period for the collection of claims by the liquidator. It also specifies the methods by
which different categories of creditors can submit and prove their claims.
Receipt or collection of claims – Section 38(1) provides that the liquidator shall receive or collect the claims
of creditors within a period of thirty days from the date of the commencement of the liquidation process.
Submission of claim by financial creditor – According to section 38(2), a financial creditor may submit a
claim to the liquidator by providing a record of such claim with an information utility.
In cases where the information relating to the claim is not recorded in the information utility, the financial creditor
may submit the claim in the same manner provided for the submission of claims for the operational creditor
under sub-section (3).
Submission of claim by operational creditor – An operational creditor may submit a claim to the liquidator in
such form and in such manner and along with such supporting documents required to prove the claim as may
be specified by the Board. [Section 38(3)]
Claims by creditor who is partly a financial and partly an operational creditor – A creditor who is partly
a financial creditor and partly an operational creditor shall submit claims to the liquidator to the extent of his
financial debt in the manner as provided in sub-section (2) and to the extent of his operational debt under sub-
section (3). [Section 38(4)]
Withdrawal or variation of claims – A creditor may withdraw or vary his claim under section 38 within fourteen
days of its submission. [Section 38(5)]
Verification of Claims
Section 39 prescribes the procedure to be followed for the verification of claims by the liquidator.
According to section 39(1), the liquidator shall verify the claims submitted under section 38 within such time as
specified by the Board.
The liquidator may require any creditor or the corporate debtor or any other person to produce any other
document or evidence which he thinks necessary for the purpose of verifying the whole or any part of the claim.
[Section 39(2)]
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 amended section 42 to provide
clarity that a creditor may appeal to the Adjudicating Authority against the decision of the liquidator in both the
scenarios i.e, acceptance or rejection of claims.
When preference shall be deemed to be given at a relevant time – Section 43(4) lays down that a preference
shall be deemed to be given at a relevant time, if –
(a) It is given to a related party (other than by reason only of being an employee), during the period of two
years preceding the insolvency commencement date; or
(b) a preference is given to a person other than a related party during the period of one year preceding the
insolvency commencement date.
(b) is a related party, it shall be presumed that the interest was acquired, or the benefit was received
otherwise than in good faith unless the contrary is shown. [Explanation I to section 44]
Effect of public announcement – A person shall be deemed to have sufficient information or opportunity to
avail such information if a public announcement regarding the corporate insolvency resolution process has
been made under section 13. [Explanation II to section 44].
“Security interest” means right, title or interest or a claim to property, created in favour of, or provided for
a secured creditor by a transaction which secures payment or performance of an obligation and includes
mortgage, charge, hypothecation, assignment and encumbrance or any other agreement or arrangement
securing payment or performance of any obligation of any person:
Provided that security interest shall not include a performance guarantee. [Section 3(31)]
Liquidator to be informed – Where the secured creditor realises security interest under clause (b) of subsection
(1), he shall inform the liquidator of such security interest and identify the asset subject to such security interest
to be realised. [Section 52(2)]
Verification by liquidator – Sub-section (3) lays down that before any security interest is realised by the
secured creditor under this section, the liquidator shall verify such security interest and permit the secured
creditor to realise only such security interest, the existence of which may be proved either –
(a) by the records of such security interest maintained by an information utility; or
(b) by such other means as may be specified by the Board.
Secured assets – A secured creditor may enforce, realise, settle, compromise or deal with the secured assets
in accordance with such law as applicable to the security interest being realised and to the secured creditor and
apply the proceeds to recover the debts due to it. [Section 52(4)]
Realisation of secured asset – Section 52(5) provides that if in the course of realising a secured asset,
any secured creditor faces resistance from the corporate debtor or any person connected therewith in taking
possession of, selling or otherwise disposing of the security, the secured creditor may make an application to
the Adjudicating Authority to facilitate the secured creditor to realise such security interest in accordance with
law for the time being in force.
The Adjudicating Authority, on the receipt of an application from a secured creditor under sub-section (5) may
pass such order as may be necessary to permit a secured creditor to realise security interest in accordance with
law for the time being in force. [Section 52(6)]
Account to the liquidator for surplus – According to section 52(7), where the enforcement of the security
interest under sub-section (4) yields an amount by way of proceeds which is in excess of the debts due to the
secured creditor, the secured creditor shall-
(a) account to the liquidator for such surplus; and
(b) tender to the liquidator any surplus funds received from the enforcement of such secured assets.
Deduction of insolvency resolution process costs – Sub-section (8) lays down that the amount of insolvency
resolution process costs, due from secured creditors who realise their security interests in the manner provided
in section 52, shall be deducted from the proceeds of any realisation by such secured creditors, and they shall
transfer such amounts to the liquidator to be included in the liquidation estate.
Unpaid debts of secured creditor – Where the proceeds of the realisation of the secured assets are not
adequate to repay debts owed to the secured creditor, the unpaid debts of such secured creditor shall be paid
by the liquidator in the manner specified in clause (e) of sub-section (1) of section 53. [Section 52(9)]
Distribution of Assets
Section 53 deals with distribution of assets in liquidation. The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 makes
significant changes in the priority of claims for distribution of liquidation proceeds. In case of liquidation, the
assets will be distributed in the following order, in case of liquidation: (i) fees of insolvency professional and
costs related to the resolution process, (ii) workmen’s dues for the preceding 24 months and secured creditors,
(iii) employee wages, (iv) unsecured creditors, (v) government dues and remaining secured creditors (any
remaining debt if they enforce their collateral), (vi) any remaining debt, and (vii) shareholders.
Lesson 7 n Liquidation of Corporate Person 133
According to priority of claims, unsecured financial creditors shall be paid before the Government. This is
intended to promote alternative sources of finance and the consequent development of bond markets in India.
“Liquidation cost” means any cost incurred by the liquidator during the period of liquidation subject to such
regulations, as may be specified by the Board. [Section 5(16)]
“Liquidation commencement date” means the date on which proceedings for liquidation commence in
accordance with section 33 or section 59, as the case may be. [Section 5(17)]
Order of priority – Sub-section (1) of section 53 provides that notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained
in any law enacted by the Parliament or any State Legislature for the time being in force, the proceeds from the
sale of the liquidation assets shall be distributed in the following order of priority and within such period as may
be specified, namely: -
(a) the insolvency resolution process costs and the liquidation costs paid in full;
(b) the following debts which shall rank equally between and among the following:
(i) workmen’s dues for the period of twenty-four months preceding the liquidation commencement
date; and
(ii) debts owed to a secured creditor in the event such secured creditor has relinquished security in
the manner set out in section 52;
(c) wages and any unpaid dues owed to employees other than workmen for the period of twelve months
preceding the liquidation commencement date;
(d) financial debts owed to unsecured creditors;
(e) the following dues shall rank equally between and among the following: -
(i) any amount due to the Central Government and the State Government including the amount to
be received on account of the Consolidated Fund of India and the Consolidated Fund of a State,
if any, in respect of the whole or any part of the period of two years preceding the liquidation
commencement date;
(ii) debts owed to a secured creditor for any amount unpaid following the enforcement of security
interest;
(f) any remaining debts and dues;
(g) preference shareholders, if any; and
(h) equity shareholders or partners, as the case may be.
Contractual arrangements between recipients with equal ranking – Sub-section (2) lays down that any
contractual arrangements between recipients under sub-section (1) with equal ranking, if disrupting the order of
priority under that sub-section shall be disregarded by the liquidator.
Deduction of fees payable to liquidator – Sub-section (3) makes provision for deduction of fees payable to
liquidator. It provides that the fees payable to the liquidator shall be deducted proportionately from the proceeds
payable to each class of recipients under sub-section (1), and the proceeds to the relevant recipient shall be
distributed after such deduction.
Explanation – The Explanation appended to section 53 clarifies that for the purpose of this section-
(i) at each stage of the distribution of proceeds in respect of a class of recipients that rank equally, each of
the debts will either be paid in full, or will be paid in equal proportion within the same class of recipients,
if the proceeds are insufficient to meet the debts in full; and
134 PP-IL&P
(ii) the term “workmen’s dues” shall have the same meaning as assigned to it in section 326 of the
Companies Act, 2013.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has made the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India
(Voluntary Liquidation Process) Regulations, 2017 to regulate the voluntary liquidation of corporate
persons under Chapter V of Part II of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Who may initiate voluntary liquidation proceedings – According to sub-section (1) of section 59, a corporate
person who intends to liquidate itself voluntarily and has not committed any default may initiate voluntary
liquidation proceedings under the provisions of Chapter V of Part II of the Code.
Thus, in order to initiate voluntary liquidation proceedings under Chapter V of Part II of the Code, a corporate
person who intends to liquidate itself voluntarily, must have not committed any default.
Procedural requirements – Sub-section (2) of section 59 provides that the voluntary liquidation of a corporate
person under sub-section (1) shall meet such conditions and procedural requirements as may be specified by
the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
Conditions for voluntary liquidation proceedings of corporate person registered as company – Sub-
section (3) of section 59 lays down that without prejudice to sub-section (2), voluntary liquidation proceedings
of a corporate person registered as a company shall meet the following conditions:
(a) a declaration from majority of the directors of the company verified by an affidavit stating that –
(i) they have made a full inquiry into the affairs of the company and they have formed an opinion that
either the company has no debt or that it will be able to pay its debts in full from the proceeds of
assets to be sold in the voluntary liquidation; and
(ii) the company is not being liquidated to defraud any person;
(b) the declaration under sub-clause (a) shall be accompanied with the following documents:
(i) audited financial statements and record of business operations of the company for the previous
two years or for the period since its incorporation, whichever is later;
(ii) a report of the valuation of the assets of the company, if any prepared by a registered valuer;
(c) within four weeks of a declaration under sub-clause (a), there shall be –
(i) a special resolution of the members of the company in a general meeting requiring the company
to be liquidated voluntarily and appointing an insolvency professional to act as the liquidator (A
sample format of resolution for voluntary liquidation and minutes of extra ordinary general meeting
of the members of the corporate person is placed as Annexure 1); or
(ii) a resolution of the members of the company in a general meeting requiring the company to be
liquidated voluntarily as a result of expiry of the period of its duration, if any, fixed by its articles or
135
136 PP-IL&P
on the occurrence of any event in respect of which the articles provide that the company shall be
dissolved, as the case may be and appointing an insolvency professional to act as the liquidator:
The proviso appended to sub-section (3) of section 59 lays down that if the company owes any debt to any
person, creditors representing two thirds in value of the debt of the company shall approve the resolution
passed under sub-clause (c) within seven days of such resolution.
Though the procedure to be followed for voluntary liquidation proceedings under Chapter III is largely similar
to the procedure to be followed for insolvent liquidation under Chapter III of the Code yet there are marked
differences:
1. To initiate voluntary liquidation proceedings, where the corporate debtor is a company, the directors
have to provide a declaration of solvency (A sample format of the Declaration of Solvency is placed
as Annexure 2) and a declaration that the company is not being liquidated to defraud any person.
2. The declarations have to be accompanied by (a) the audited financial statements of the company and
(b) a record of its business operations for the previous two years or the period since its incorporation
whichever is later.
3. Further, a report of the valuation of the assets of the company prepared by a registered valuer has to
be provided.
4. A resolution in favour of the voluntary winding up of the company and appointment of an insolvency
professional as the liquidator has to be passed within four weeks of the declaration under clause (a)
of sub-section (3) of section 59.
5. Where the company owes any debt to any person, creditors representing two-thirds in value of the
debt of the company shall approve the resolution passed under sub-clause (c) within seven days of
such resolution.
Requirement of notification – Sub-section (4) lays down that the company shall notify the Registrar of
Companies and the Board about the resolution under sub-section (3) to liquidate the company within seven
days of such resolution or the subsequent approval by the creditors, as the case may be.
Date of Commencement of voluntary liquidation proceedings – According to sub-section (5), subject to approval
of the creditors under sub-section (3), the voluntary liquidation proceedings in respect of a company shall be deemed
to have commenced from the date of passing of the resolution under sub-clause (c) of sub-section (3).
Provisions to apply – The provisions of sections 35 to 53 of Chapter III and Chapter VII shall apply to voluntary
liquidation proceedings for corporate persons with such modifications as may be necessary. [Section 59(6)]
Application to Adjudicating Authority – As per sub-section (7) of section 59, where the affairs of the corporate
person have been completely wound up, and its assets completely liquidated, the liquidator shall make an
application to the Adjudicating Authority for the dissolution of such corporate person.
Order by Adjudicating Authority – The Adjudicating Authority shall on an application filed by the liquidator
under sub-section (7), pass an order that the corporate debtor shall be dissolved from the date of that order and
the corporate debtor shall be dissolved accordingly. [Section 59(8)]
Thus, once the affairs of the corporate debtor have been wound up and its assets completely liquidated, the
liquidator shall make an application to the adjudicating authority for the dissolution of the corporate debtor and
the corporate debtor shall be dissolved by the order of the adjudicating authority.
Copy of Order – A copy of an order under sub-section (8) shall within fourteen days from the date of such order,
be forwarded to the authority with which the corporate person is registered. [Section 59(9)]
Preservation of records
The liquidator is required to preserve a physical or an electronic copy of the reports, registers and books of
account referred to in Regulations 8 and 10 for at least eight years after the dissolution of the corporate person,
either with himself or with an information utility. (Regulation 41 Voluntary Liquidation Process Regulations).
Lesson 8 n Voluntary Liquidation of Companies 137
FLOWCHART
FLOWCHART
• To approve voluntary
Liquidation
• To approve declaration of
Solvency
CONVENING A BOARD
• For appointment of
MEETING liquidator,
registered valuer ; subject to
shareholder’s approval
To be accompanied by
FILING DECLARATION OF latest two years audited
SOLVENCY WITH ROC, financial statements or for a
VERIFIED BY AN AFFIDAVIT TO period since incorporation
BE PROVIDED BY MAJORITY as the case may be
OF DIRECTORS/ DESIGNATED Report of valuation of the
PARTNERS (T) company if any by
registered valuer
To be made in
1. In English and regional
(T+28+5) daily
To make a public announcement 2. On the website of
in FORM A corporate debtor
(T+28+5) 3. At public.ann@ibbi.gov.in
Receipt of claims and preparing a list of Last date within 30 days from
stakeholders (T+30) insolvency commencement
date
Copy of order to be submitted to the Within 14 days from the date of such
authority with which the such order order
corporate person is registered
Annexure 1
Annexure 2
DECLARATION OF SOLVENCY
We, Mr. X and Mr. P , only directors of ABC Private Limited do solemnly affirm and declare that we have made
a full enquiry into the affairs of this company, and that having done so, we have formed the opinion that this
Company has no debts or if claimed during the liquidation process, the company will be able to pay its debts/
claims in full from the proceeds of assets to be sold in liquidation within a period of six months from the date
of commencement of liquidation, and we append a statement of the Company’s assets and liabilities as at
....................... being the latest practicable date before the making of this declaration. We also solemnly affirm
and declared that no business and no transaction of any kind has been carried for the period from .......................
Lesson 8 n Voluntary Liquidation of Companies 141
till the date of the Board Meeting to be held on xx.xx.xx17 in which Declaration of solvency has been placed,
and we make this solemn declaration believing the same to be true.
The Declaration of solvency has been submitted to the Board Meeting not to defraud the Creditors, Government,
any other company, firm and other person.
Solemnly affirmed and declare at (PLACE) on (DATE), before me.
_________________
Mr. X
DIN: xxxxx
Address:
_________________
Mr. Y
DIN: xxxxx
Address:
142 PP-IL&P
Lesson 9
Adjudication and Appeals for Corporate
Persons
Introduction
Understanding of Adjudicating Authority and its jurisdiction enables an applicant to file the application in right
forum. Time is the essence of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (31 of 2016) and to ensure effective
and successful implementation of the Code; adherence to the timelines prescribed under the Code is of
utmost importance. Adjudicating Authority is one of the key institutional pillars and backbone of the insolvency
ecosystem of India.
Adjudicating Authority plays a two-fold role while functioning under the Code. One role is administrative in
nature and other is judicial in nature. By administrative it means that Adjudicating Authority has to ascertain
whether a particular case is complete in terms of Section 7/9/10 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016
(as the case may be) or it suffers from some defect. Whereas by judicial it means to decide whether to admit
corporate insolvency resolution process or liquidation of a corporate debtor or not.
This Lesson enables a reader to understand:
• Adjudicating Authority for dealing with corporate insolvency resolution process and corporate liquidation.
• Appellate Authority under the Code and timeline to prefer appeal.
• NCLT Benches across India and their jurisdiction.
• Applicability of Limitation Act, 1963 for proceedings undergoing the Code.
• Penalty provisions for initiating fraudulent or malicious proceedings under the Code.
• Penalty provisions where corporate debtor is involved in fraudulent or wrongful trading.
To ensure better understanding of readers about the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (31 of 2016) and
its applicability; reference to various case laws have also been made.
143
144 PP-IL&P
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, where a
corporate insolvency resolution process or liquidation proceeding of a corporate debtor is pending before
a National Company Law Tribunal, an application relating to insolvency resolution process or liquidation or
bankruptcy of a corporate guarantor or personal guarantor of such corporate debtor (as the case may be) shall
be filed before the NCLT.
In the case of State Bank of India v/s. D.S Rajendra Kumar, it is observed that if corporate insolvency resolution
process of corporate debtor has been initiated before NCLT, then insolvency resolution process of personal
guarantor of the corporate debtor can be initiated before same NCLT Bench instead of Debt Recovery Tribunal
(“DRT”).Further it was also held in this case that order of moratorium is applicable only to the proceedings
against corporate debtor and the personal guarantor not applicable for filing application for initiating corporate
insolvency resolution process against the guarantor or personal guarantor (NCLAT order dated 18th April, 2018)
However corporate insolvency resolution process or liquidation or bankruptcy proceeding of a corporate
guarantor or personal guarantor (as the case may be) pending in any court or tribunal shall be transferred to
the AA dealing with corporate insolvency resolution process or liquidation proceeding of such corporate debtor.
In the case of Sanjeev Shriya v/s. State Bank of India, Allahabad High Court held that two parallel proceeding
against the corporate debtor and the personal guarantor cannot go simultaneously in two different jurisdictions.
(Allahabad High Court order dated 6th September, 2017)
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in any other law for the time being in force, NCLT shall have
jurisdiction to entertain or dispose of:
a) any application or proceeding by or against the corporate debtor or corporate person;
b) any claim made by or against the corporate debtor or corporate person, including claims by or against
any of its subsidiaries situated in India; and
c) any question of priorities or any question of law or facts, arising out of or in relation to the insolvency
resolution or liquidation proceedings of the corporate debtor or corporate person under this Code.
AA has jurisdiction to entertain or dispose of an application or proceeding by or against the corporate debtor or
corporate person including any claim made by or against the corporate debtor or corporate person, including
claims by or against any of its subsidiaries situated in India.
Notwithstanding anything contained in the Limitation Act, 1963 or in any other law for the time being in force,
in computing the period of limitation specified for any suit or application by or against a corporate debtor for
which an order of moratorium has been passed, the period during which such moratorium is in place shall be
excluded.
b) There has been material irregularity in exercise of the powers by the resolution professional during the
corporate insolvency resolution period;
c) The debts owed to operational creditors of the corporate debtor have not been provided for in the
resolution plan in the manner specified by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India (“Board”);
d) The insolvency resolution process costs have not been provided for repayment in priority to all other
debts; or
e) The resolution plan does not comply with any other criteria specified by the Board.
An appeal against a liquidation order passed under Section 33 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016
(31 of 2016) may be filed on grounds of material irregularity or fraud committed in relation to such a liquidation
order.
In the case of Steel Konnect (India) Private Limited v/s. Hero Fincorp Ltd., Initially Courts were of view that
once an insolvency application is admitted, the Code does not permit erstwhile company directors to maintain
an appeal on behalf of the corporate debtor and only the interim resolution professional (“IRP”) can maintain an
appeal on behalf of the company. This contention
Further, it was observed the power of the IRP as provided under the Code does not include the power to
initiate proceedings on behalf of the Corporate Debtor. The aforesaid issue was raised in Steel Konnect (India)
Pvt Ltd v M/s Hero Fincorp Ltd, where it was held that upon admission of application under the Insolvency
and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 and commencement of corporate insolvency resolution process, for preferring
an appeal before NCLAT; the corporate debtor can appear through its Board of Directors or its officer or its
authorized representative.
If corporate debtor is represented before AA during appeal through its Board of Directors, no objection can be
raised in this regard as initiation of corporate insolvency resolution process only suspends functioning of Board
of Directors in that corporate debtor not the Board of Directors as a whole. Also, the directors continue to be in
their position and are still present in the records maintained by the Registrar of Companies and are just put in
temporary suspension for 180/270 days till continuation of the insolvency resolution process. (NCLAT order
dated 29th August, 2017)
In the case of Uttam Galva Steels Limited v/s. Union of India, Bombay High Court provided interim protection
to the petitioners to withdraw the petition with the liberty to petitioners to prefer appeal under Section 61 of the
Code. Bombay High Court also stated that since Interim Resolution Professional has not been appointed in the
said case and keeping in view the consequences of appointment of Interim Resolution Professional, Bombay
High Court in the interest of justice directed not to appoint Interim Resolution professional from next two weeks
from the date of this order thereby allowing time to the petitioner to prefer an appeal. Order also provided that
interim protection provided by the Court shall not be considered as expression of view of the Bombay High
Court by the Appellate Authority while deciding the appeal. (Bombay High Court order dated 20th April, 2017)
NCLT
Appeal within 30 days
from the date of passing
NCLT Order + one time
15 days extension (if
allowed)
NCLAT
Appeal within 45 days
from the date of passing
NCLAT Order + one time
15 days extension (if
allowed)
SUPREME
COURT
S. No. Name of the NCLT Bench Location Territorial Jurisdiction of the NCLT Bench
1 a) Principal Bench New Delhi Union territory of Delhi
b) New Delhi Bench
2 Ahmedabad Bench Ahmedabad State of Gujarat, State of Madhya Pradesh,
Union territory of Dadra and Nagar Haveli and
Union territory of Daman and Diu
Case Law
Unigreen Global Private Limited v/s. Punjab National Bank: Where AA has passed an order imposing
penalty under Section 65 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (31 of 2016) without exercising principle
of natural justice; then such order cannot be upheld having been passed in violation of rules of natural justice.
(NCLAT order dated 1st December, 2017)
b) such director or partner did not exercise due diligence in minimising the potential loss to the creditors
of the corporate debtor.
Explanation – For the purposes of this Section a director or partner of the corporate debtor (as the case may
be) shall be deemed to have exercised due diligence if such diligence was reasonably expected of a person
carrying out the same functions as are carried out by such director or partner, as the case may be, in relation
to the corporate debtor.
INTRODUCTION
In the traditional lending process, a bank makes a loan, maintaining it as an asset on its balance sheet, collecting
principal and interest, and monitoring whether there is any deterioration in borrower’s creditworthiness.
This requires a bank to hold assets till repayment of loan. The funds of the bank are blocked in these loans and
to meet its growing fund requirement a bank has to raise additional funds from the market. Securitisation is a
way of unlocking these blocked funds.
One of the most prominent developments in international finance in recent decades and the one that is likely
to assume even greater importance in future is securitisation. Securitisation is the process of pooling and
repackaging of homogenous illiquid financial assets into marketable securities that can be sold to investors.
Basically Securitisation is a method of raising funds by way of selling receivables for money.
The process leads to the creation of financial instruments that represent ownership interest in, or are secured
by a segregated income producing asset or pool of assets. The pool of assets collateralises securities. These
assets are generally secured by personal or real property (e.g. automobiles, real estate, or equipment loans),
but in some cases are unsecured (e.g. credit card debt, consumer loans).
149
150 PP-IL&P
reaching consequences. This Act is having the overriding power over the other legislation and it shall go in
addition to and not in derogation of certain legislation.
The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002
enacted with a view to regulate securitisation and reconstruction of financial assets and enforcement of security
interest and for matters connected therewith or incidental thereto. The Act enables the banks and financial
institutions to realise long-term assets, manage problems of liquidity, asset liability mismatch and improve
recovery by exercising powers to take possession of securities, sell them and reduce non- performing assets
by adopting measures for recovery or reconstruction. The said Act further provides for setting up of asset
reconstruction companies which are empowered to take possession of secured assets of the borrower including
the right to transfer by way of lease, assignment or sale and realise the secured assets and take over the
management of the business of the borrower.
With increasing levels of non-performing or stressed assets in the Indian financial services sector, reforming
the debt recovery and bankruptcy framework has been a key focus area for the Indian government. The
Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws and Miscellaneous Provisions (Amendment)
Bill, 2016 was introduced by the Minister of Finance, Mr. Arun Jaitley, in LokSabha on May 11, 2016. It seeks to
amend four laws: (i) Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest
Act, 2002 (SARFAESI), (ii) Recovery of Debts due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 (RDDBFI), (iii)
Indian Stamp Act, 1899 and (iv) Depositories Act, 1996.
Following the recent enactment of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (Bankruptcy Code), the Indian
parliament has passed the Enforcement of Security Interests and Recovery of Debt Laws and Miscellaneous
Provisions (Amendment) Act, 2016 to improve the efficacy of Indian debt recovery laws. The amendment act
introduces a number of changes to the Securitization and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement
of Security Interests Act, 2002 (SARFAESI Act) and the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial
Institutions Act, 1993 (DRT Act). These changes will however come into effect as and when the government
issues appropriate notifications in the Official Gazette to implement the relevant provisions of the amendment.
possession of securities, sell them and reduce non-performing assets by adopting measures for recovery or
reconstruction.”
The main purpose of the SARFAESI Act is to enable and empower the secured creditors to take possession
of their securities and to deal with them without the intervention of the court and also alternatively to authorise
any securitisation or reconstruction company to acquire financial assets of any bank or financial institution.
The SARFAESI Act, 2002 has empowered the Banks and Financial Institutions with vast power to enforce the
securities charged to them. The Banks can now issue notices to the defaulters to pay up the dues and if they fail
to do so within 60 days of the date of the notice, the banks can take over the possession of assets like factory,
land and building, plant and machinery etc. charged to them including the right to transfer by way of lease,
assignment or sale and realize the secured assets. In case the borrower refuses peaceful handing over of the
secured assets, the bank can also file an application before the relevant Magistrate for taking possession of
assets. The Banks can also take over the management of business of the borrower. The bank in addition can
appoint any person to manage the secured assets the possession of which has been taken over by the bank.
Banks can package and sell loans via “Securitisation” and the same can be traded in the market like bonds and
shares.
that such a procedure/mechanism was conducive to the principles of fairness and that such a procedure was
also important from the point of view of the economy of the country and would serve the purpose in the growth
of a healthy economy. It would serve as guidance to secured debtors in general in conducting their affairs.
The court opined that the fairness doctrine, cannot be stretched too far, such communication is only for the
purposes of the secured debtors knowledge and cannot give an occasion to the secured debtor to resort to any
proceeding, which are not permissible under the provisions of the Act. Thus, a secured debtor is not allowed to
challenge the reasons communicated or challenge the action likely to be taken by the secured creditor at that
point of time unless his right to approach the DRT as provided under section 17 matures on any measure having
been taken under Sub-section (4) of Section 13.
Moreover, another safeguard is also available to a secured borrower within the framework of the Act i.e. to
approach the DRT under Section 17 though such a right accrues only after measures are taken under Sub-
section (1) of Section 13.
The Hon’ble Supreme Court, however, found that the requirement of deposit of 75 per cent of the amount
claimed before entertaining an appeal (petition) under Section 17 is an oppressive, onerous and arbitrary
condition and against all the canons of reasonableness. Held this provision to be invalid and ordered that it was
liable to be struck down.
Definitions
Section 2 of The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest
Act, 2002 (SARFAESI Act) defines various terms used in the Act.
Section 2 (1): In the SARFAESI Act, unless the context otherwise requires,-
(a) “Appellate Tribunal” means a Debts Recovery Appellate Tribunal established under sub-section (1) of
section 8 of the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 (51 of 1993);
(b) “asset reconstruction” means acquisition by any [asset reconstruction company] of any right or interest
of any bank or financial institution in any financial assistance for the purpose of realisation of such
financial assistance;
(ba) “asset reconstruction company” means a company registered with Reserve Bank under section 3 for
the purposes of carrying on the business of asset reconstruction or securitisation, or both;
(c) “bank”means –
(i) a banking company; or
(ii) a corresponding new bank; or
(iii) the State Bank of India; or
(iv) a subsidiary bank; or
(iva) a multi-State co-operative bank; or
(v) such other bank which the Central Government may, by notification, specify for the purposes of
this Act;
(f) “borrower” means any person who has been granted financial assistance by any bank or financial
institution or who has given any guarantee or created any mortgage or pledge as security for the
financial assistance granted by any bank or financial institution and includes a person who becomes
borrower of a asset reconstruction company consequent upon acquisition by it of any rights or interest
of any bank or financial institution in relation to such financial assistance or who has raised funds
through issue of debt securities.
Lesson 10 n Debt Recovery & Securitization 153
(g) “Central Registry” means the registry set up or cause to be set up under sub-section (1) of section 20;
(ga) “company” means a company as defined in clause (20) of section 2 of the Companies Act, 2013
(ha) “debt” shall have the meaning assigned to it in clause (g) of section 2 of the Recovery of Debts Due to
Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 (51 of 1993) and includes –
(i) unpaid portion of the purchase price of any tangible asset given on hire or financial lease or
conditional sale or under any other contract;
(ii) any right, title or interest on any intangible asset or licence or assignment of such intangible asset,
which secures the obligation to pay any unpaid portion of the purchase price of such intangible
asset or an obligation incurred or credit otherwise extended to enable any borrower to acquire the
intangible asset or obtain licence of such asset;
(i) “Debts Recovery Tribunal” means the Tribunal established under sub-section (1) of section 3 of the
Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993; name changed Recovery of
Debts and Bankruptcy Act, 1993
(ia) “debt securities” means debt securities listed in accordance with the regulations made by the Board
under the Securities and Exchange Board of India Act, 1992.
(j) “default” means –
(ii) non-payment of any debt or any other amount payable by the borrower to any secured creditor
consequent upon which the account of such borrower is classified as non-performing asset in the
books of account of the secured creditor; or
(iii) non-payment of any debt or any other amount payable by the borrower with respect to debt
securities after notice of ninety days demanding payment of dues served upon such borrower by
the debenture trustee or any other authority in whose favour security interest is created for the
benefit of holders of such debt securities;
(k) “financial assistance” means any loan or advance granted or any debentures or bonds subscribed or
any guarantees given or letters of credit established or any other credit facility extended by any bank or
financial institution [including funds provided for the purpose of acquisition of any tangible asset on hire
or financial lease or conditional sale or under any other contract or obtaining assignment or licence of
any intangible asset or purchase of debt securities;
(l) “financial asset” means debt or receivables and includes –
(i) a claim to any debt or receivables or part thereof, whether secured or unsecured; or
(ii) any debt or receivables secured by, mortgage of, or charge on, immovable property; or
(iii) a mortgage, charge, hypothecation or pledge of movable property; or
(iv) any right or interest in the security, whether full or part underlying such debt or receivables; or
(v) any beneficial interest in property, whether movable or immovable, or in such debt, receivables,
whether such interest is existing, future, accruing, conditional or contingent; or
(va) any beneficial right, title or interest in any tangible asset given on hire or financial lease or
conditional sale or under any other contract which secures the obligation to pay any unpaid portion
of the purchase price of such asset or an obligation incurred or credit otherwise provided to enable
the borrower to acquire such tangible asset; or
(vb) any right, title or interest on any intangible asset or licence or assignment of such intangible asset,
which secures the obligation to pay any unpaid portion of the purchase price of such intangible
154 PP-IL&P
asset or an obligation incurred or credit otherwise extended to enable the borrower to acquire
such intangible asset or obtain licence of the intangible asset; or
(vi) any financial assistance;
(m) “financial institution” means –
i. a public financial institution within the meaning of section 4A of the Companies Act, 1956;
ii. any institution specified by the Central Government under sub-clause (ii) of clause (h) of section
2 of the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993;
iii. the International Finance Corporation established under the International Finance Corporation
(Status, Immunities and Privileges) Act, 1958
(iiia) a debenture trustee registered with the Board and appointed for secured debt securities;
(iiib) asset reconstruction company, whether acting as such or mana-ging a trust created for the
purpose of securitisation or asset reconstruction, as the case may be
iv. any other institution or non-banking financial company as defined in clause (f) of section 45-I of
the Reserve Bank of India Act, 1934, which the Central Government may, by notification, specify
as financial institution for the purposes of this Act;
(ma) “financial lease” means a lease under any lease agreement of tangible asset, other than negotiable
instrument or negotiable document, for transfer of lessor’s right therein to the lessee for a certain time
in consideration of payment of agreed amount periodically and where the lessee becomes the owner of
the such assets at the expiry of the term of lease or on payment of the agreed residual amount, as the
case may be;
(n) “hypothecation” means a charge in or upon any movable property, existing or future, created by a
borrower in favour of a secured creditor without delivery of possession of the movable property to such
creditor, as a security for financial assistance and includes floating charge and crystallisation of such
charge into fixed charge on movable property;
(na) “negotiable document” means a document, which embodies a right to delivery of tangible assets and
satisfies the requirements for negotiability under any law for the time being in force including warehouse
receipt and bill of lading;
(o) “non-performing asset” means an asset or account of a borrower, which has been classified by a bank
or financial institution as sub-standard, [doubtful or loss asset, –
a) in case such bank or financial institution is administered or regulated by any authority or body
established, constituted or appointed by any law for the time being in force, in accordance with
the directions or guidelines relating to assets classifications issued by such authority or body;
b) in any other case, in accordance with the directions or guidelines relating to assets classifications
issued by the Reserve Bank;
(q) “obligor” means a person liable to the originator, whether under a contract or otherwise, to pay a
financial asset or to discharge any obligation in respect of a financial asset, whether existing, future,
conditional or contingent and includes the borrower;
(r) “originator” means the owner of a financial asset which is acquired by a asset reconstruction company
for the purpose of securitisation or asset reconstruction;
(s) “property” means –
i) immovable property;
Lesson 10 n Debt Recovery & Securitization 155
(zg) “security receipt” means a receipt or other security, issued by a asset reconstruction company to any
qualified buyer pursuant to a scheme, evidencing the purchase or acquisition by the holder thereof, of
an undivided right, title or interest in the financial asset involved in securitisation;
(b) that such asset reconstruction company has made adequate arrangements for realisation of the
financial assets acquired for the purpose of securitisation or asset reconstruction and shall be
able to pay periodical returns and redeem on respective due dates on the investments made in
the company by the qualified buyers or other persons;
(c) that the directors of asset reconstruction company have adequate professional experience in
matters related to finance, securitisation and reconstruction;
(d) [***]
(e) that any of its directors has not been convicted of any offence involving moral turpitude;
[(f) that a sponsor of an asset reconstruction company is a fit and proper person in accordance with
the criteria as may be specified in the guidelines issued by the Reserve Bank for such persons;
(g) that asset reconstruction company has complied with or is in a position to comply with prudential
norms specified by the Reserve Bank;
[(h) that asset reconstruction company has complied with one or more conditions specified in the
guidelines issued by the Reserve Bank for the said purpose.
(4) The Reserve Bank may, after being satisfied that the conditions specified in sub-section (3) are fulfilled,
grant a certificate of registration to the asset reconstruction company to commence or carry on business
of securitisation or asset reconstruction, subject to such conditions, which it may consider, fit to impose.
(5) The Reserve Bank may reject the application made under sub-section (2) if it is satisfied that the
conditions specified in sub-section (3) are not fulfilled:
Provided that before rejecting the application, the applicant shall be given a reasonable opportunity of
being heard.
(6) Every asset reconstruction company, shall obtain prior approval of the Reserve Bank for any substantial
change in its management including appointment of any director on the board of directors of the asset
reconstruction company or managing director or chief executive officer thereof or change of location of
its registered office or change in its name:
Provided that the decision of the Reserve Bank, whether the change in management of a asset reconstruction
company is a substantial change in its management or not, shall be final.
Explanation. – For the purposes of this section, the expression “substantial change in management” means the
change in the management by way of transfer of shares or change affecting the sponsorship in the company by
way of transfer of shares or amalgamation or transfer of the business of the company.
(e) fails to –
I. comply with any direction issued by the Reserve Bank under the provisions of this Act; or
II. maintain accounts in accordance with the requirements of any law or any direction or order
issued by the Reserve Bank under the provisions of this Act; or
III. submit or offer for inspection its books of account or other relevant documents when so
demanded by the Reserve Bank; or
IV. obtain prior approval of the Reserve Bank required under sub-section (6) of section 3:
Provided that before cancelling a certificate of registration on the ground that the asset reconstruction
company has failed to comply with the provisions of clause (c) or has failed to fulfil any of the conditions
referred to in clause (d) or sub-clause (iv) of clause (e), the Reserve Bank, unless it is of the opinion
that the delay in cancelling the certificate of registration granted under sub-section (4) of section 3 shall
be prejudicial to the public interest or the interests of the investors or the asset reconstruction company,
shall give an opportunity to such company on such terms as the Reserve Bank may specify for taking
necessary steps to comply with such provisions or fulfilment of such conditions.
(2) A asset reconstruction company aggrieved by the order of cancellation of certificate of registration may
prefer an appeal, within a period of thirty days from the date on which [such order of cancellation] is
communicated to it, to the Central Government:
Provided that before rejecting an appeal such company shall be given a reasonable opportunity of
being heard.
(3) A asset reconstruction company, which is holding investments of qualified buyers and whose application
for grant of certificate of registration has been rejected or certificate of registration has been cancelled
shall, notwithstanding such rejection or cancellation be deemed to be a asset reconstruction company
until it repays the entire investments held by it (together with interest, if any) within such period as the
Reserve Bank may direct.
acquisition, be deemed to be the lender and all the rights of such bank or financial institution shall vest
in such company in relation to such financial assets.
(2A) If the bank or financial institution is holding any right, title or interest upon any tangible asset or intangible
asset to secure payment of any unpaid portion of the purchase price of such asset or an obligation
incurred or credit otherwise provided to enable the borrower to acquire the tangible asset or assignment
or licence of intangible asset, such right, title or interest shall vest in the asset reconstruction company
on acquisition of such assets under sub-section (1).
(3) Unless otherwise expressly provided by this Act, all contracts, deeds, bonds, agreements, powers-of-
attorney, grants of legal representation, permissions, approvals, consents or no-objections under any
law or otherwise and other instruments of whatever nature which relate to the said financial asset and
which are subsisting or having effect immediately before the acquisition of financial asset under sub-
section (1) and to which the concerned bank or financial institution is a party or which are in favour of
such bank or financial institution shall, after the acquisition of the financial assets, be of as full force
and effect against or in favour of the asset reconstruction company, as the case may be, and may be
enforced or acted upon as fully and effectually as if, in the place of the said bank or financial institution,
asset reconstruction company, as the case may be, had been a party thereto or as if they had been
issued in favour of asset reconstruction company, as the case may be.
(4) If, on the date of acquisition of financial asset under sub-section (1), any suit, appeal or other proceeding
of whatever nature relating to the said financial asset is pending by or against the bank or financial
institution, save as provided in the third proviso to sub-section (1) of section 15 of the Sick Industrial
Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 the same shall not abate, or be discontinued or be, in any
way, prejudicially affected by reason of the acquisition of financial asset by the asset reconstruction
company, as the case may be, but the suit, appeal or other proceeding may be continued, prosecuted
and enforced by or against the asset reconstruction company, as the case may be.
(5) On acquisition of financial assets under sub-section (1), the asset reconstruction company, may with
the consent of the originator, file an application before the Debts Recovery Tribunal or the Appellate
Tribunal or any court or other Authority for the purpose of substitution of its name in any pending suit,
appeal or other proceedings and on receipt of such application, such Debts Recovery Tribunal or the
Appellate Tribunal or court or Authority shall pass orders for the substitution of the asset reconstruction
company in such pending suit, appeal or other proceedings.
Transfer of pending applications to any one of Debts Recovery Tribunals in certain cases
(Section 5A)
(1) If any financial asset, of a borrower acquired by a asset reconstruction company, comprise of secured
debts of more than one bank or financial institution for recovery of which such banks or financial
institutions has filed applications before two or more Debts Recovery Tribunals, the asset reconstruction
company may file an application to the Appellate Tribunal having jurisdiction over any of such Tribunals
in which such applications are pending for transfer of all pending applications to any one of the Debts
Recovery Tribunals as it deems fit.
(2) On receipt of such application for transfer of all pending applications under sub-section (1), the Appellate
Tribunal may, after giving the parties to the application an opportunity of being heard, pass an order for
transfer of the pending applications to any one of the Debts Recovery Tribunals.
(3) Notwithstanding anything contained in the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions
Act, 1993, any order passed by the Appellate Tribunal under sub-section (2) shall be binding on all
the Debts Recovery Tribunals referred to in sub-section (1) as if such order had been passed by the
Appellate Tribunal having jurisdiction on each such Debts Recovery Tribunal.
160 PP-IL&P
(4) Any recovery certificate, issued by the Debts Recovery Tribunal to which all the pending applications
are transferred under sub-section (2), shall be executed in accordance with the provisions contained
in sub-section (23) of section 19 and other provisions of the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and
Financial Institutions Act, 1993 shall, accordingly, apply to such execution.
(4) The qualified buyers shall, at a meeting called under sub-section (3), follow the same procedure, as
nearly as possible as is followed at meetings of the board of directors of the asset reconstruction
company, as the case may be.
Power of Reserve Bank to determine policy and issue directions (Section 12, 12A and 12B)
Section 12 deals with the power of Reserve Bank to determine policy and issue directions.
(1) If the Reserve Bank is satisfied that in the public interest or to regulate financial system of the country to its
advantage or to prevent the affairs of any asset reconstruction company from being conducted in a manner
detrimental to the interest of investors or in any manner prejudicial to the interest of such asset reconstruction
company, it is necessary or expedient so to do, it may determine the policy and give directions to all or
any asset reconstruction company in matters relating to income recognition, accounting standards, making
provisions for bad and doubtful debts, capital adequacy based on risk weights for assets and also relating
to deployment of funds by the asset reconstruction company, as the case may be, and such company shall
be bound to follow the policy so determined and the directions so issued.
(2) Without prejudice to the generality of the power vested under sub-section (1), the Reserve Bank may
give directions to any asset reconstruction company generally or to a class of asset reconstruction
companies or to any asset reconstruction company in particular as to –
(a) the type of financial asset of a bank or financial institution which can be acquired and procedure
for acquisition of such assets and valuation thereof;
(b) the aggregate value of financial assets which may be acquired by any asset reconstruction
company;
(c) the fee and other charges which may be charged or incurred for management of financial assets
acquired by any asset reconstruction company;
(d) transfer of security receipts issued to qualified buyers.
Section 12A deals with the power of Reserve Bank to call for statements and information.
It states that the Reserve Bank may at any time direct a asset reconstruction company to furnish it within such
Lesson 10 n Debt Recovery & Securitization 163
time as may be specified by the Reserve Bank, with such statements and information relating to the business
or affairs of such asset reconstruction company (including any business or affairs with which such company is
concerned) as the Reserve Bank may consider necessary or expedient to obtain for the purposes of this Act.
Section 12B deals with the power of Reserve Bank to carry out audit and inspection.
(1) The Reserve Bank may, for the purposes of this Act, carry out or caused to be carried out audit and
inspection of an asset reconstruction company from time to time.
(2) It shall be the duty of an asset reconstruction company and its officers to provide assistance and co-
operation to the Reserve Bank to carry out audit or inspection under sub-section (1).
(3) Where on audit or inspection or otherwise, the Reserve Bank is satisfied that business of an asset
reconstruction company is being conducted in a manner detrimental to public interest or to the interests
of investors in security receipts issued by such asset reconstruction company, the Reserve Bank may,
for securing proper management of an asset reconstruction company, by an order –
(a) remove the Chairman or any director or appoint additional directors on the board of directors of
the asset reconstruction company; or
(b) appoint any of its officers as an observer to observe the working of the board of directors of such
asset reconstruction company:
Provided that no order for removal of Chairman or director under clause (a) shall be made except after
giving him an opportunity of being heard.
(4) It shall be the duty of every director or other officer or employee of the asset reconstruction company
to produce before the person, conducting an audit or inspection under sub-section (1), all such books,
accounts and other documents in his custody or control and to provide him such statements and
information relating to the affairs of the asset reconstruction company as may be required by such
person within the stipulated time specified by him.
(3A) If, on receipt of the notice under sub-section (2), the borrower makes any representation or raises
any objection, the secured creditor shall consider such representation or objection and if the secured
creditor comes to the conclusion that such representation or objection is not acceptable or tenable, he
shall communicate within fifteen days of receipt of such representation or objection the reasons for non-
acceptance of the representation or objection to the borrower:
Provided that the reasons so communicated or the likely action of the secured creditor at the stage of
communication of reasons shall not confer any right upon the borrower to prefer an application to the
Debts Recovery Tribunal under section 17 or the Court of District Judge under section 17A.
(4) In case the borrower fails to discharge his liability in full within the period specified in sub-section (2),
the secured creditor may take recourse to one or more of the following measures to recover his secured
debt, namely : –
(a) take possession of the secured assets of the borrower including the right to transfer by way of
lease, assignment or sale for realising the secured asset;
(b) take over the management of the business of the borrower including the right to transfer by way
of lease, assignment or sale for realising the secured asset :
Provided that the right to transfer by way of lease, assignment or sale shall be exercised only
where the substantial part of the business of the borrower is held as security for the debt :
Provided further that where the management of whole of the business or part of the business is
severable, the secured creditor shall take over the management of such business of the borrower
which is relatable to the security for the debt;
(c) appoint any person (hereafter referred to as the manager), to manage the secured assets the
possession of which has been taken over by the secured creditor;
(d) require at any time by notice in writing, any person who has acquired any of the secured assets
from the borrower and from whom any money is due or may become due to the borrower, to pay
the secured creditor, so much of the money as is sufficient to pay the secured debt.
(5) Any payment made by any person to the secured creditor shall give such person a valid discharge as
if he has made payment to the borrower.
(5A) Where the sale of an immovable property, for which a reserve price has been specified, has been
postponed for want of a bid of an amount not less than such reserve price, it shall be lawful for any
officer of the secured creditor, if so authorised by the secured creditor in this behalf, to bid for the
immovable property on behalf of the secured creditor at any subsequent sale.
(5B) Where the secured creditor, referred to in sub-section (5A), is declared to be the purchaser of the
immovable property at any subsequent sale, the amount of the purchase price shall be adjusted towards
the amount of the claim of the secured creditor for which the auction of enforcement of security interest
is taken by the secured creditor, under sub-section (4) of section 13.
(5C) The provisions of section 9 of the Banking Regulation Act, 1949 shall, as far as may be, apply to the
immovable property acquired by secured creditor under sub-section (5A).
(6) Any transfer of secured asset after taking possession thereof or takeover of management, by the
secured creditor or by the manager on behalf of the secured creditor shall vest in the transferee all
rights in, or in relation to, the secured asset transferred as if the transfer had been made by the owner
of such secured asset.
(7) Where any action has been taken against a borrower, all costs, charges and expenses which, in the
opinion of the secured creditor, have been properly incurred by him or any expenses incidental thereto,
Lesson 10 n Debt Recovery & Securitization 165
shall be recoverable from the borrower and the money which is received by the secured creditor shall,
in the absence of any contract to the contrary, be held by him in trust, to be applied, firstly, in payment
of such costs, charges and expenses and secondly, in discharge of the dues of the secured creditor and
the residue of the money so received shall be paid to the person entitled thereto in accordance with his
rights and interests.
(8) Where the amount of dues of the secured creditor together with all costs, charges and expenses
incurred by him is tendered to the secured creditor at any time before the date of publication of notice
for public auction or inviting quotations or tender from public or private treaty for transfer by way of
lease, assignment or sale of the secured assets, –
(i) the secured assets shall not be transferred by way of lease assignment or sale by the secured
creditor; and
(ii) in case, any step has been taken by the secured creditor for transfer by way of lease or assignment
or sale of the assets before tendering of such amount under this sub-section, no further step shall
be taken by such secured creditor for transfer by way of lease or assignment or sale of such
secured assets.
(9) Subject to the provisions of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, in the case of financing of a
financial asset by more than one secured creditors or joint financing of a financial asset by secured
creditors, no secured creditor shall be entitled to exercise any or all of the rights conferred on him under
or pursuant to sub-section (4) unless exercise of such right is agreed upon by the secured creditors
representing not less than sixty per cent in value of the amount outstanding as on a record date and
such action shall be binding on all the secured creditors :
Provided that in the case of a company in liquidation, the amount realised from the sale of secured
assets shall be distributed in accordance with the provisions of Act:
Provided further that in the case of a company being wound up on or after the commencement of this
Act, the secured creditor of such company, who opts to realise his security instead of relinquishing his
security and proving his debt under the Act, 1956, may retain the sale proceeds of his secured assets
after depositing the workmen’s dues with the liquidator in accordance with the provisions of the Act:
Provided also that the liquidator referred to in the second proviso shall intimate the secured creditor
the workmen’s dues in accordance with the provisions of the 1956 and in case such workmen’s dues
cannot be ascertained, the liquidator shall intimate the estimated amount of workmen’s dues under that
section to the secured creditor and in such case the secured creditor may retain the sale proceeds of
the secured assets after depositing the amount of such estimated dues with the liquidator:
Provided also that in case the secured creditor deposits the estimated amount of workmen’s dues,
such creditor shall be liable to pay the balance of the workmen’s dues or entitled to receive the excess
amount, if any, deposited by the secured creditor with the liquidator:
Provided also that the secured creditor shall furnish an undertaking to the liquidator to pay the balance
of the workmen’s dues, if any.
Explanation. – For the purposes of this sub-section, –
(a) “record date” means the date agreed upon by the secured creditors representing not less than
[sixty per cent] in value of the amount outstanding on such date;
(b) “amount outstanding” shall include principal, interest and any other dues payable by the borrower
to the secured creditor in respect of secured asset as per the books of account of the secured
creditor.
166 PP-IL&P
(10) Where dues of the secured creditor are not fully satisfied with the sale proceeds of the secured assets,
the secured creditor may file an application in the form and manner as may be prescribed to the Debts
Recovery Tribunal having jurisdiction or a competent court, as the case may be, for recovery of the
balance amount from the borrower.
(11) Without prejudice to the rights conferred on the secured creditor under or by this section, the secured
creditor shall be entitled to proceed against the guarantors or sell the pledged assets without first taking
any of the measures specified in clauses (a) to (d) of sub-section (4) in relation to the secured assets
under this Act.
(12) The rights of a secured creditor under this Act may be exercised by one or more of his officers authorised
in this behalf in such manner as may be prescribed.
(13) No borrower shall, after receipt of notice from the secured creditor transfer by way of sale, lease or
otherwise (other than in the ordinary course of his business) any of his secured assets referred to in the
notice, without prior written consent of the secured creditor.
(viii) the borrower has not made any repayment of the financial assistance in spite of the above notice
and the Authorised Officer is, therefore, entitled to take possession of the secured assets under
the provisions of sub-section (4) of section 13 read with section 14 of the principal Act;
(ix) that the provisions of the Act and the rules made thereunder had been complied with.
Provided further that on receipt of the affidavit from the Authorised Officer, the District Magistrate or the
Chief Metropolitan Magistrate, as the case may be, shall after satisfying the contents of the affidavit
pass suitable orders for the purpose of taking possession of the secured assets within a period of thirty
days from the date of application.
Provided further that if no order is passed by the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate or District Magistrate
within the said period of thirty days for reasons beyond his control, he may, after recording reasons
in writing for the same, pass the order within such further period but not exceeding in aggregate sixty
days:
Provided also that the requirement of filing affidavit stated in the first proviso shall not apply to proceeding
pending before any District Magistrate or the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate, as the case may be, on the
date of commencement of this Act.
(1A) The District Magistrate or the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate may authorise any officer subordinate to
him, –
(i) to take possession of such assets and documents relating thereto; and
(ii) to forward such assets and documents to the secured creditor.
For the purpose of securing compliance with the provisions of sub-section (1), the Chief
Metropolitan Magistrate or the District Magistrate may take or cause to be taken such steps and
use, or cause to be used, such force, as may, in his opinion, be necessary.
(2) No act of the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate or the District Magistrate any officer authorised by
the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate or District Magistrate done in pursuance of this section shall be
called in question in any court or before any authority.
office as such immediately before publication of the notice under sub-section (1), shall be deemed
to be terminated;
(c) the directors or the administrators appointed under this section shall take such steps as may be
necessary to take into their custody or under their control all the property, effects and actionable
claims to which the business of the borrower is, or appears to be, entitled and all the property and
effects of the business of the borrower shall be deemed to be in the custody of the directors or
administrators, as the case may be, as from the date of the publication of the notice;
(d) the directors appointed under this section shall, for all purposes, be the directors of the company
of the borrower and such directors or as the case may be, the administrators appointed under this
section, shall alone be entitled to exercise all the powers of the directors or as the case may be,
of the persons exercising powers of superintendence, direction and control, of the business of the
borrower whether such powers are derived from the memorandum or articles of association of the
company of the borrower or from any other source whatsoever.
(3) Where the management of the business of a borrower, being a company as defined in the Companies
Act, 1956, is taken over by the secured creditor, then, notwithstanding anything contained in the said
Act or in the memorandum or articles of association of such borrower, –
(a) it shall not be lawful for the shareholders of such company or any other person to nominate or
appoint any person to be a director of the company;
(b) no resolution passed at any meeting of the shareholders of such company shall be given effect to
unless approved by the secured creditor;
(c) no proceeding for the winding up of such company or for the appointment of a receiver in respect
thereof shall lie in any court, except with the consent of the secured creditor.
(4) Where the management of the business of a borrower had been taken over by the secured creditor, the
secured creditor shall, on realisation of his debt in full, restore the management of the business of the
borrower to him:
Provided that if any secured creditor jointly with other secured creditors or any asset reconstruction company
or financial institution or any other assignee has converted part of its debt into shares of a borrower company
and thereby acquired controlling interest in the borrower company, such secured creditors shall not be liable to
restore the management of the business to such borrower.
Provided that different fees may be prescribed for making the application by the borrower and the person other
than the borrower.
Explanation. – For the removal of doubts, it is hereby declared that the communication of the reasons to the
borrower by the secured creditor for not having accepted his representation or objection or the likely action
of the secured creditor at the stage of communication of reasons to the borrower shall not entitle the person
(including borrower) to make an application to the Debts Recovery Tribunal under this sub-section.
(1A) An application under sub-section (1) shall be filed before the Debts Recovery Tribunal within the local
limits of whose jurisdiction –
(a) the cause of action, wholly or in part, arises;
(b) where the secured asset is located; or
(c) the branch or any other office of a bank or financial institution is maintaining an account in which
debt claimed is outstanding for the time being.
(2) The Debts Recovery Tribunal shall consider whether any of the measures referred to in sub-section
(4) of section 13 taken by the secured creditor for enforcement of security are in accordance with the
provisions of this Act and the rules made thereunder.
(3) If, the Debts Recovery Tribunal, after examining the facts and circumstances of the case and evidence
produced by the parties, comes to the conclusion that any of the measures referred to in sub-section
(4) of section 13, taken by the secured creditor are not in accordance with the provisions of this Act and
the rules made thereunder, and require restoration of the management or restoration of possession, of
the secured assets to the borrower or other aggrieved person, it may, by order, –
(a) declare the recourse to any one or more measures referred to in sub-section (4) of section 13
taken by the secured creditor as invalid; and
(b) restore the possession of secured assets or management of secured assets to the borrower or
such other aggrieved person, who has made an application under sub-section (1), as the case
may be; and
(c) pass such other direction as it may consider appropriate and necessary in relation to any of the
recourse taken by the secured creditor under sub-section (4) of section 13.
(4) If, the Debts Recovery Tribunal declares the recourse taken by a secured creditor under sub-section
(4) of section 13, is in accordance with the provisions of this Act and the rules made thereunder, then,
notwithstanding anything contained in any other law for the time being in force, the secured creditor
shall be entitled to take recourse to one or more of the measures specified under sub-section (4) of
section 13 to recover his secured debt.
(4A) Where –
(i) any person, in an application under sub-section (1), claims any tenancy or leasehold rights upon
the secured asset, the Debt Recovery Tribunal, after examining the facts of the case and evidence
produced by the parties in relation to such claims shall, for the purposes of enforcement of security
interest, have the jurisdiction to examine whether lease or tenancy, –
a. has expired or stood determined; or
b. is contrary to section 65A of the Transfer of Property Act, 1882; or
c. is contrary to terms of mortgage; or
d. is created after the issuance of notice of default and demand by the Bank under sub-section
(2) of section 13 of the Act; and
170 PP-IL&P
(ii) the Debt Recovery Tribunal is satisfied that tenancy right or leasehold rights claimed in secured
asset falls under the sub-clause (a) or sub-clause (b) or sub-clause (c) or sub- clause (d) of clause
(i), then notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in any other law for the time being
in force, the Debt Recovery Tribunal may pass such order as it deems fit in accordance with the
provisions of this Act.
(5) Any application made under sub-section (1) shall be dealt with by the Debts Recovery Tribunal as
expeditiously as possible and disposed of within sixty days from the date of such application :
Provided that the Debts Recovery Tribunal may, from time to time, extend the said period for reasons to
be recorded in writing, so, however, that the total period of pendency of the application with the Debts
Recovery Tribunal, shall not exceed four months from the date of making of such application made
under sub-section (1).
(6) If the application is not disposed of by the Debts Recovery Tribunal within the period of four months
as specified in sub-section (5), any part to the application may make an application, in such form as
may be prescribed, to the Appellate Tribunal for directing the Debts Recovery Tribunal for expeditious
disposal of the application pending before the Debts Recovery Tribunal and the Appellate Tribunal may,
on such application, make an order for expeditious disposal of the pending application by the Debts
Recovery Tribunal.
(7) Save as otherwise provided in this Act, the Debts Recovery Tribunal shall, as far may be, dispose of
application in accordance with the provisions of the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial
Institutions Act, 1993 and the rules made thereunder.
(a) the secured creditor by whom the caveat has been lodged (hereafter in this section referred to as
the caveator) shall serve notice of the caveat by registered post, acknowledgement due, on the
person by whom the application has been or is expected to be made under sub- section (1);
(b) any person by whom the caveat has been lodged (hereafter in this section referred to as the
caveator) shall serve notice of the caveat by registered post, acknowledgement due, on the
person by whom the application has been or is expected to be made under sub-section (1).
(3) Where after a caveat has been lodged under sub-section (1), any application or appeal is filed before
the Tribunal or the court of District Judge or the Appellate Tribunal or the High Court, as the case may
be, the Tribunal or the District Judge or the Appellate Tribunal or the High Court, as the case may be,
shall serve a notice of application or appeal filed by the applicant or the appellant on the caveator.
(4) Where a notice of any caveat has been served on the applicant or the Appellant, he shall periodically
furnish the caveator with a copy of the application or the appeal made by him and also with copies
of any paper or document which has been or may be filed by him in support of the application or the
appeal.
(5) Where a caveat has been lodged under sub-section (1), such caveat shall not remain in force after the
expiry of the period of ninety days from the date on which it was lodged unless the application or appeal
referred to in sub-section (1) has been made before the expiry of the said period.
Right of borrower to receive compensation and costs in certain cases (Section 19)
Section 19 provides that if the Debts Recovery Tribunal or the Court of District Judge, on an application made
under section 17 or section 17A or the Appellate Tribunal or the High Court on an appeal preferred under section
18 or section 18A, holds that the possession of secured assets by the secured creditor is not in accordance with
the provisions of this Act and rules made thereunder and directs the secured creditors to return such secured
assets to the concerned borrowers or any other aggrieved person, who has filed the application under section
17 or section 17A or appeal under section 18 or section 18A, as the case may be, the borrower or such other
person shall be entitled to the payment of such compensation and costs as may be determined by such Tribunal
or Court of District Judge or Appellate Tribunal or the High Court referred to in section 18B.
Delegation of powers
Section 20B deals with the Delegation of powers. It provides that the Central Government may, by notification,
delegate its powers and functions under this Chapter, in relation to establishment, operations and regulation of
the Central Registry to the Reserve Bank, subject to such terms and conditions as may be prescribed.
electronic form, under sub-section (2), any reference in this Act to entry in the Central Register shall be
construed as a reference to any entry as maintained in computer or in any other electronic form.
(4) The register shall be kept under the control and management of the Central Registrar.
Right to Inspect
Section 26 deals with the right to inspect particulars of securitisation, reconstruction and security interest
transactions. Section 26 provides that:
(1) The particulars of securitisation or reconstruction or security interest entered in the Central Register of
such transactions kept under section 22 shall be open during the business hours for inspection by any
person on payment of such fee as may be prescribed.
(2) The Central Register referred to in sub-section (1) maintained in electronic form, shall also be open
during the business hours for the inspection by any person through electronic media on payment of
such fee as may be prescribed.
Penalties
Section 27 provides that if a default is made –
176 PP-IL&P
(a) in filing under section 23, the particulars of every transaction of any securitisation or asset reconstruction
or security interest created by asset reconstruction company or secured creditor; or
(b) in sending under section 24, the particulars of the modification referred to in that section; or
(c) in giving intimation under section 25,
every company and every officer of the company or the secured creditor and every officer of the secured
creditor who is in default shall be punishable with fine which may extend to five thousand rupees for every day
during which the default continues:
Provided that provisions of this section shall be deemed to have been omitted from the date of coming into
force of the provisions of this Chapter and section 23 as amended by the Enforcement of Security Interest and
Recovery of Debts Laws and Miscellaneous Provisions (Amendment) Act, 2016.
Offences
Any person who contravenes the provisions of this Act or of any rules made thereunder shall be punishable with
imprisonment for a term which may extend to one year, or with fine, or with both.
determine and no injunction shall be granted by any court or other authority in respect of any action taken or to
be taken in pursuance of any power conferred by or under this Act or under the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks
and Financial Institutions Act, 1993.
Demand notice
Rule 3 (1) provides that the service of demand notice as referred to in sub-section (2) of section 13 of the
SRFAESI Act shall be made by delivering including hand delivery or transmitting at the place where the borrower
or his agent, empowered to accept the notice or documents on behalf of the borrower, actually and voluntarily
resides or carries on business or personally works for gain, by registered post with acknowledgement due,
addressed to the borrower or his agent empowered to accept the service or by Speed Post or by courier or by
any other means of transmission of documents like fax message or electronic mail service.
Provided that where authorised officer has reason to believe that the borrower or his agent is avoiding the
service of the notice or that for any other reason, the service cannot be made as aforesaid, the service shall be
effected by affixing a copy of the demand notice on the outer door or some other conspicuous part of the house
or building in which the borrower or his agent ordinarily resides or carries on business or personally works for
gain and also by publishing the contents of the demand notice in two leading newspapers, one in vernacular
language, having sufficient circulation in that locality.
(2) Where the borrower is a body corporate, the demand notice shall be served on the registered office or any
of the branches of such body corporate as specified under sub-rule (1).
(3) Any other notice in writing to be served on the borrower or his agent by authorisedofficer, shall be served in
the same manner as provided in this rule.
(4) Where there are more than one borrower, the demand notice shall be served on each borrower.
(5) The demand notice may invite attention of the borrower to provisions of sub-section (8) of section 13 of the
Act, in respect of time available to the borrower, to redeem the secured assets.
(a) If on examining the representation made or objection raised by the borrower, the secured creditor is
satisfied that there is a need to make any changes or modifications in the demand notice, he shall
modify the notice accordingly and serve a revised notice or pass such other suitable orders as deemed
necessary, within fifteen days from the date of receipt of the representation or objection.
(b) If on examining the representation made or objection raised, the Authorized Officer comes to the
conclusion that such representation or objection is not acceptable or tenable, he shall communicate
within [fifteen days]63 of receipt of such representation or objection, the reasons for non-acceptance of
the representation or objection, to the borrower
of any person other than the secured creditor. A copy of the notice so sent may be endorsed
to the concerned body corporate’s Registrar to the issue or share transfer agents, if any;
(iii) in the case of other movable property (except as aforesaid), calling upon the borrowers and
the person in possession to hand over the same to the authorised officer and the authorised
officer shall take custody of such movable property in the same manner as provided in sub-
rules (1) to (3) above;
(iv) movable secured assets other than those covered in this rule shall be taken possession
of by the authorised officer by taking possession of the documents evidencing title to such
secured assets.
(3) Sale by any methods other than public auction or public tender, shall be on such terms as may be
settled between the secured creditors and the proposed purchaser.
(6) The authorised officer shall serve to the borrower a notice of thirty days for sale of the immovable
secured assets, under sub-rule (5) :
Provided that if the sale of such secured asset is being effected by either inviting tenders from the public
or by holding public auction, the secured creditor shall cause a public notice in two leading newspapers
one in vernacular language having sufficient circulation in the locality by setting out the terms of sale,
which shall include, –
(a) the description of the immovable property to be sold, including the details of the encumbrances
known to the secured creditor;
(b) the secured debt for recovery of which the property is to be sold;
(c) reserve price, below which the property may not be sold;
(d) time and place of public auction or the time after which sale by any other mode shall be completed;
depositing earnest money as may be stipulated by the secured creditor;
(e) any other thing which the authorised officer considers it material for a purchaser to know in order
to judge the nature and value of the property.
(7) Every notice of sale shall be affixed on a conspicuous part of the immovable property and may, if the
authorised officer deems it fit, put on the web-site of the secured creditor on the Internet.
(8) Sale by any method other than public auction or public tender, shall be on such terms as may be settled
between the secured creditor and the proposed purchaser in writing.
Time of sale, issue of sale certificate and delivery of possession, etc. (Rule 9)
(1) No sale of immovable property under these rules, in first instance shall take place before the expiry of thirty
days from the date on which the public notice of sale is published in newspapers as referred to in the proviso to
sub-rule (6) of rule 8 or notice of sale has been served to the borrower:
Provided further that if sale of immovable property by any one of the methods specified by sub-rule (5) of rule
8 fails and sale is required to be conducted again, the authorised officer shall serve, affix and publish notice of
sale of not less than fifteen days to the borrower, for any subsequent sale.
(2) The sale shall be confirmed in favour of the purchaser who has offered the highest sale price in his bid or
tender or quotation or offer to the authorised officer and shall be subject to confirmation by the secured creditor:
Provided that no sale under this rule shall be confirmed, if the amount offered by sale price is less than the
public notice of sale is published in newspapers as referred to in the proviso to sub-rule (6) or notice of sale has
been served to the borrower reserve price, specified under sub-rule (5) of rule 8 :
Provided further that if the authorised officer fails to obtain a price higher than the reserve price, he may, with
the consent of the borrower and the secured creditor effect the sale at such price.
(3) On every sale of immovable property, the purchaser shall immediately, i.e. on the same day or not later than
next working day, as the case may be, pay a deposit of twenty five per cent of the amount of the sale price,
which is inclusive of earnest money deposited, if any, to the authorised officer conducting the sale and in default
of such deposit, the property shall be sold again.
(4) The balance amount of purchase price payable shall be paid by the purchaser to the authorised officer on
or before the fifteenth day of confirmation of sale of the immovable property or such extended period as may
be agreed upon in writing between the purchaser and the secured creditor, in any case not exceeding three
months.
(5) In default of payment within the period mentioned in sub-rule (4), the deposit shall be forfeited and the
182 PP-IL&P
property shall be resold and the defaulting purchaser shall forfeit all claim to the property or to any part of the
sum for which it may be subsequently sold.
(6) On confirmation of sale by the secured creditor and if the terms of payment have been complied with, the
authorised officer exercising the power of sale shall issue a certificate of sale of the immovable property in
favour of the purchaser in the form given in Appendix V to these rules.
(7) Where the immovable property sold is subject to any encumbrances, the authorised officer may, if he thinks
fit, allow the purchaser to deposit with him the money required to discharge the encumbrances and any interest
due thereon together with such additional amount that may be sufficient to meet the contingencies or further
cost, expenses and interest as may be determined by him.
Provided that it after meeting the cost of removing encumbrances and contingencies there is any surplus
available out of the money deposited by the purchaser such surplus shall be paid to the purchaser within fifteen
day, from date of finalisation of the sale.
(8) On such deposit of money for discharge of the encumbrances, the authorised officer [shall issue or cause
the purchaser to issue notices to the persons interested in or entitled to the money deposited with him and take
steps to make the payment accordingly.
(9) The authorised officer shall deliver the property to the purchaser free from encumbrances known to the
secured creditor on deposit of money as specified in sub-rule (7) above.
(10) The certificate of sale issued under sub-rule (6) shall specifically mention that whether the purchaser has
purchased the immovable secured asset free from any encumbrances known to the secured creditor or not.
(2) The provisions of the Debts Recovery Tribunal (Procedure) Rules, 1993 made under Recovery of Debts Due
to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 (51 of 1993), shall mutatis mutandis apply to any application filed
by under sub-rule (1).
(3) An application under sub-rule (1) shall be accompanied with fee as provided in rule 7 of the Debts Recovery
Tribunal (Procedure) Rules, 1993.
DEBT RECOVERY
1. Substituted for “Due to Banks and Financial Institutions” by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, w.e.f. a date yet to be notified.
2. Inserted by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, w.e.f. a date yet to be notified.
3. Substituted for “The provisions of this Act” by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, w.e.f. a date yet to be notified.
184 PP-IL&P
The Debts Recovery Tribunals can appoint Receivers, Commissioners, pass ex-parte orders, ad-interim orders,
interim orders apart from powers to review its own decision and hear appeals against orders passed by the
Recovery Officers of the Tribunals :
The recording of evidence by Debts Recovery Tribunals is somewhat unique. All evidences are taken by way of
an affidavit. Cross examination is allowed only on request by the defense, and that too if the Tribunal feels that
such a cross examination is in the interest of justice. Frivolous cross examination may be denied. There are a
number of other unique features in the proceedings before the Debts Recovery Tribunals all aimed at expediting
the proceedings.
Any liability (inclusive of interest) which is claimed as due from any person by a bank or a financial institution or
by a consortium of banks or financial institutions during the course of any business activity undertaken by the
bank or the financial institution or the consortium under any law for the time being in force, in cash or otherwise,
whether secured or unsecured, or assigned, or whether payable under a decree or order of any civil court or
any arbitration award or otherwise or under a mortgage and subsisting on, and legally recoverable on, the date
of the application.
Important Definitions
Section 2 of the Recovery of Debts [and Bankruptcy]4 Act, 1993 (the Act) defines various terms used in the Act,
as given under:
“Appellate Tribunal” means an Appellate Tribunal established under sub-section (1) of Section 8.[ Section 2(a)]
“Bank” means
(i) banking company;
(ii) a corresponding new bank;
(iii) State Bank of India;
(iv) a subsidiary bank; or
(v) a Regional Rural Bank;
(vi) a multi State co-operative bank [Section 2(d)]
“Banking Company” shall have the meaning assigned to it in clause (c) of section 5 of the Banking Regulation
Act, 1949 [Section 2(e)]
“Chairperson” means a chairperson of an Appellate Tribunal appointed under Section 9. [Section 2(ea)]
“Debts” means any liability (inclusive of interest) which is claimed as due from any person [Section 2(g)]
by a bank or a financial institution or by a consortium of banks or financial institutions during the course of
any business activity undertaken by the bank or the financial institution or the consortium under any law
for the time being in force, in cash or otherwise, whether secured or unsecured, or assigned, or whether
payable under a decree or order of any civil court or any arbitration award or otherwise or under a mortgage
and subsisting on, and legally recoverable on, the date of the application [and includes any liability towards
debt securities which remains unpaid in full or part after notice of ninety days served upon the borrower by
the debenture trustee or any other authority in whose favour security interest is created for the benefit of
holders of debt securities or;
Debt securities” means debt securities listed in accordance with regulations made by the Securities and
Exchange Board of India under the Securities and Exchange Board of India Act, 1992[ Section 2(ga)]
4. Substituted for “Due to Banks and Financial Institutions” by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, w.e.f. a date yet to be notified.
Lesson 10 n Debt Recovery & Securitization 185
ESTABLISHMENT OF TRIBUNAL
Section 3 of the Act deals with the establishment of tribunal. Section 3 states that:
(1) The Central Government shall, by notification, establish one or more Tribunals, to be known as the
Debts Recovery Tribunal, to exercise the jurisdiction, powers and authority conferred on such Tribunal
by or under this Act.
(1A) The Central Government shall by notification establish such number of Debts Recovery Tribunals and
its benches as it may consider necessary, to exercise the jurisdiction, powers and authority of the
Adjudicating Authority conferred on such Tribunal by or under the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code,
2016.
(2) The Central Government shall also specify, in the notification referred to in sub-section (1), the areas
within which the Tribunal may exercise jurisdiction for entertaining and deciding the applications filed
before it.
186 PP-IL&P
(1A) The Central Government shall, by notification, establish such number of Debt Recovery Appellate
Tribunals to exercise jurisdiction, powers and authority to entertain appeal against the order made by
the Adjudicating Authority under Part III of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
(2) The Central Government shall also specify in the notification referred to in sub-section (1) the Tribunals
in relation to which the Appellate Tribunal may exercise jurisdiction.
(3) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-sections (1) and (2), the Central Government may authorise
the Chairperson of one Appellate Tribunal to discharge also the functions of the Chairperson of other
Appellate Tribunal.
Provided further that any application made under the first proviso for seeking permission from the Debts Recovery
Tribunal to withdraw the application made under sub-section (1) shall be dealt with by it as expeditiously as
possible and disposed of within thirty days from the date of such application:
Provided also that in case the Debts Recovery Tribunal refuses to grant permission for withdrawal of the
application filed under this sub-section, it shall pass such orders after recording the reasons therefor.
(1A) Every bank being, multi-State co-operative bank referred to in sub-clause (vi) of clause (d) of section 2,
may, at its option, opt to initiate proceedings under the Multi-State Co-operative Societies Act, 2002 (39 of 2002)
to recover debts, whether due before or after the date of commencement of the Enforcement of the Security
Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 from any person instead of making an application
under this Chapter.
(1B) In case, a bank being, multi-State co-operative bank referred to in sub-clause (vi) of clause (d) of section
2 has filed an application under this Chapter and subsequently opts to withdraw the application for the purpose
of initiating proceeding under the Multi-State Co-operative Societies Act, 2002 (39 of 2002) to recover debts, it
may do so with the permission of the Tribunal and every such application seeking permission from the Tribunal
to withdraw the application made under sub-section (1A) shall be dealt with by it as expeditiously as possible
and disposed of within thirty days from the date of such application:
Provided that in case the Tribunal refuses to grant permission for withdrawal of the application filed under this
sub-section, it shall pass such orders after recording the reasons therefor.
(2) Where a bank or a financial institution, which has to recover its debt from any person, has filed an application
to the Tribunal under sub-section (1) and against the same person another bank or financial institution also has
a claim to recover its debt, then, the later bank or financial institution may join the applicant bank or financial
institution at any stage of the proceedings, before the final order is passed, by making an application to that
Tribunal.
(3) Every application under sub-section (1) or sub-section (2) shall be in such form, and shall be accompanied
with true copies of all documents relied on in support of the claim along with such fee, as may be prescribed:
Provided that the fee may be prescribed having regard to the amount of debt to be recovered:
Provided further that nothing contained in this sub-section relating to fee shall apply to cases transferred to the
Tribunal under sub-section (1) of section 31.
[Explanation – For the purposes of this section, documents includes statement of account or any entry in
banker’s book duly certified under the Bankers’ Books Evidence Act, 1891
(3A) Every applicant in the application filed under sub-section (1) or sub-section (2) for recovery of debt, shall –
(a) state particulars of the debt secured by security interest over properties or assets belonging to any of
the defendants and the estimated value of such securities;
(b) if the estimated value of securities is not sufficient to satisfy the debt claimed, state particulars of any
other properties or assets owned by any of the defendants, if any; and
(c) if the estimated value of such other assets is not sufficient to recover the debt, seek an order directing the
defendant to disclose to the Tribunal particulars of other properties or assets owned by the defendants.
(3B) If any application filed before the Tribunal for recovery of any debt is settled prior to the commencement of
the hearing before that Tribunal or at any stage of the proceedings before the final order is passed, the applicant
may be granted refund of the fees paid by him at such rates as may be prescribed.
(4) On receipt of application under sub-section (1) or sub-section (2), the Tribunal shall issue summons with
following directions to the defendant –
190 PP-IL&P
(i) to show cause within thirty days of the service of summons as to why relief prayed for should not be
granted;
(ii) direct the defendant to disclose particulars of properties or assets other than properties and assets
specified by the applicant under clauses (a) and (b) of sub-section (3A); and
(iii) to restrain the defendant from dealing with or disposing of such assets and properties disclosed under
clause (c) of sub-section (3A) pending the hearing and disposal of the application for attachment of
properties
(4A) Notwithstanding anything contained in section 65A of the Transfer of Property Act, 1882, the defendant, on
service of summons, shall not transfer by way of sale, lease or otherwise except in the ordinary course of his
business any of the assets over which security interest is created and other properties and assets specified or
disclosed under sub-section (3A), without the prior approval of the Tribunal:
Provided that the Tribunal shall not grant such approval without giving notice to the applicant bank or financial
institution to show cause as to why approval prayed for should not be granted:
Provided further that defendant shall be liable to account for the sale proceeds realised by sale of secured
assets in the ordinary course of business and deposit such sale proceeds in the account maintained with the
bank or financial institution holding security interest over such assets.
(5) (i) The defendant shall within a period of thirty days from the date of service of summons, present a written
statement of his defence including claim for set-off under sub-section (6) or a counter-claim under sub-
section (8), if any, and such written statement shall be accompanied with original documents or true
copies thereof with the leave of the Tribunal, relied on by the defendant in his defence:
Provided that where the defendant fails to file the written statement within the said period of thirty days,
the Presiding Officer may, in exceptional cases and in special circumstances to be recorded in writing,
extend the said period by such further period not exceeding fifteen days to file the written statement of
his defence;
(ii) where the defendant makes a disclosure of any property or asset pursuant to orders passed by the
Tribunal, the provisions of sub-section (4A) of this section shall apply to such property or asset;
(iii) in case of non-compliance of any order made under clause (ii) of sub-section (4), the Presiding Officer
may, by an order, direct that the person or officer who is in default, be detained in civil prison for a term
not exceeding three months unless in the meantime the Presiding Officer directs his release:
Provided that the Presiding Officer shall not pass an order under this clause without giving an opportunity of
being heard to such person or officer.
Explanation. – For the purpose of this section, the expression ‘officer who is in default’ shall mean such officer
as defined in clause (60) of section 2 of the Companies Act, 2013.
(5A) On receipt of the written statement of defendant or on expiry of time granted by the Tribunal to file the
written statement, the Tribunal shall fix a date of hearing for admission or denial of documents produced by the
parties to the proceedings and also for continuation or vacation of the interim order passed under sub-section
(4).
(5B) Where a defendant makes an admission of the full or part of the amount of debt due to a bank or financial
institution, the Tribunal shall order such defendant to pay the amount, to the extent of the admission within a
period of thirty days from the date of such order failing which the Tribunal may issue a certificate in accordance
with the provisions of sub-section (22) to the extent of the amount of debt due admitted by the defendant.
(6) Where the defendant claims to set-off against the applicant’s demand any ascertained sum of money legally
recoverable by him from such applicant, the defendant may, at the first hearing of the application, but not
Lesson 10 n Debt Recovery & Securitization 191
afterwards unless permitted by the Tribunal, present a written statement containing the particulars of the debt
sought to be set-off along with original documents and other evidence relied on in support of claim of set-off in
relation to any ascertained sum of money, against the applicant.
(7) The written statement shall have the same effect as a plaint in a cross-suit so as to enable the Tribunal to
pass a final order in respect of both the original claim and of the set-off.
(8) A defendant in an application may, in addition to his right of pleading a set-off under sub-section (6), set up,
by way of counter-claim against the claim of the applicant, any right or claim in respect of a cause of action
accruing to the defendant against the applicant either before or after the filing of the application but before the
defendant has delivered his defense or before the time limited for delivering his defence has expired, whether
such counter-claim is in the nature of a claim for damages or not.
(9) A counter-claim under sub-section (8) shall have the same effect as a cross-suit so as to enable the Tribunal
to pass a final order on the same application, both on the original claim and on the counter- claim.
(10) The applicant shall be at liberty to file a written statement in answer to the counter-claim of the defendant
within such period as may be prescribed.
(10A) Every application under sub-section (3) or written statement of defendant under sub-section (5) or claim
of set-off under sub-section (6) or a counter-claim under sub-section (8) by the defendant, or written statement
by the applicant in reply to the counter-claim, under sub-section (10) or any other pleading whatsoever, shall
be supported by an affidavit sworn in by the applicant or defendant verifying all the facts and pleadings,
the statements pleading documents and other documentary evidence annexed to the application or written
statement or reply to set-off or counter-claim, as the case may be:
Provided that if there is any evidence of witnesses to be led by any party, the affidavits of such witnesses shall
be filed simultaneously by the party with the application or written statement or replies filed under sub-section
(10A).
(10B) If any of the facts or pleadings in the application or written statement are not verified in the manner
provided under sub-section (10A), a party to the proceedings shall not be allowed to rely on such facts or
pleadings as evidence or any of the matters set out therein.
(11) Where a defendant sets up a counter-claim in the written statement and in reply to such claim the applicant
contends that the claim thereby raised ought not to be disposed of by way of counter-claim but in an independent
action, the Tribunal shall decide such issue along with the claim of the applicant for recovery of the debt.
(12) [***]
(13) (A) Where, at any stage of the proceedings, [the Tribunal on an application made by the applicant along with
particulars of property to be attached and estimated value thereof, or otherwise is satisfied that the defendant,
with intent to obstruct or delay or frustrate the execution of any order for the recovery of debt that may be
passed against him, –
(i) is about to dispose of the whole or any part of his property; or
(ii) is about to remove the whole or any part of his property from the local limits of the jurisdiction of the
Tribunal; or
(iii) is likely to cause any damage or mischief to the property or affect its value by misuse or creating third
party interest,
the Tribunal may direct the defendant, within a time to be fixed by it, either to furnish security, in such sum as
may be specified in the order, to produce and place at the disposal of the Tribunal, when required, the said
property or the value of the same, or such portion thereof as may be sufficient to satisfy the certificate for the
recovery of debt, or to appear and show cause why he should not furnish security.
192 PP-IL&P
(B) Where the defendant fails to show cause why he should not furnish security, or fails to furnish the security
required, within the time fixed by the Tribunal, the Tribunal may order the attachment of the whole or such
portion of the properties claimed by the applicant as the properties secured in his favour or otherwise owned by
the defendant as appears sufficient to satisfy any certificate for the recovery of debt.
(14) [***]
(15) The Tribunal may also in the order direct the conditional attachment of the whole or any portion of the
property specified under sub-section (13)
(16) If an order of attachment is made without complying with the provisions of sub-section (13), such attachment
shall be void.
(17) In the case of disobedience of an order made by the Tribunal under sub-sections (12), (13) and or breach
of any of the terms on which the order was made, the Tribunal may order the properties of the person guilty of
such disobedience or breach to be attached and may also order such person to be detained in the civil prison
for a term not exceeding three months, unless in the meantime the Tribunal directs his release.
(18) Where it appears to the Tribunal to be just and convenient, the Tribunal may, by order, –
(a) appoint a receiver of any property, whether before or after grant of certificate for recovery of debt;
(b) remove any person from the possession or custody of the property;
(c) commit the same to the possession, custody or management of the receiver;
(d) confer upon the receiver all such powers, as to bringing and defending suits in the courts or filing and
defending applications before the Tribunal and for the realization, management, protection, preservation
and improvement of the property, the collection of the rents and profits thereof, the application and
disposal of such rents and profits, and the execution of documents as the owner himself has, or such
of those powers as the Tribunal thinks fit; and
(e) appoint a Commissioner for preparation of an inventory of the properties of the defendant or for the sale
thereof.
(19) Where a certificate of recovery is issued against a company as defined under the Companies Act, 2013
(18 of 2013) and such company is under liquidation, the Tribunal may by an order direct that the sale proceeds
of secured assets of such company be distributed in the same manner as provided in section 326 of the
Companies Act, 2013 or under any other law for the time being in force.
(20) The Tribunal may, after giving the applicant and the defendant, an opportunity of being heard, in respect
of all claims, set-off or counter-claim, if any, and interest on such claims, within thirty days from the date of
conclusion of the hearings, pass interim or final order as it deems fit which may include order for payment
of interest from the date on which payment of the amount is found due up to the date of realisation or actual
payment.
(20A) Where it is proved to the satisfaction of the Tribunal that the claim of the applicant has been adjusted
wholly or in part by any lawful agreement or compromise in writing and signed by the parties or where the
defendant has repaid or agreed to repay the claim of the applicant, the Tribunal shall pass orders recording
such agreement, compromise or satisfaction of the claim.
(20AA) While passing the final order under sub-section (20), the Tribunal shall clearly specify the assets of
the borrower over which security interest is created in favour of any bank or financial institution and direct the
Recovery Officers to distribute the sale proceeds of such assets as provided in sub-section (20AB).
(20AB) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in any law for the time being in force, the proceeds
from sale of secured assets shall be distributed in the following orders of priority, namely: –
Lesson 10 n Debt Recovery & Securitization 193
(i) the costs incurred for preservation and protection of secured assets, the costs of valuation, public
notice for possession and auction and other expenses for sale of assets shall be paid in full;
(ii) debts owed to the bank or financial institution.
Explanation – For the purposes of this sub-section, it is hereby clarified that on or after the commencement of the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (31 of 2016), in cases where insolvency and bankruptcy proceedings
are pending in respect of secured assets of the borrower, the distribution of proceeds from sale of secured
assets shall be subject to the order of priority as provided in that Code.
(21) (i) The Tribunal shall send a copy of its final order and the recovery certificate, to the applicant and defendant.
(ii) The applicant and the defendant may obtain copy of any order passed by the Tribunal on payment on such
fee as may be prescribed.
[(22) The Presiding Officer shall issue a certificate of recovery along with the final order, under sub- section (20),
for payment of debt with interest under his signature to the Recovery Officer for recovery of the amount of debt
specified in the certificate.
(22A) Any recovery certificate issued by the Presiding Officer under sub-section (22) shall be deemed to be
decree or order of the Court for the purposes of initiation of winding up proceedings against a company registered
under the Companies Act, 2013 (18 of 2013) or Limited Liability Partnership registered under the Limited Liability
Partnership Act, 2008 (9 of 2008) or insolvency proceedings against any individual or partnership firm under any
law for the time being in force, as the case may be.
(23) Where the Tribunal, which has issued a certificate of recovery, is satisfied that the property is situated
within the local limits of the jurisdiction of two or more Tribunals, it may send the copies of the certificate of
recovery for execution to such other Tribunals where the property is situated :
Provided that in a case where the Tribunal to which the certificate of recovery is sent for execution finds that it
has no jurisdiction to comply with the certificate of recovery, it shall return the same to the Tribunal which has
issued it.
(24) The application made to the Tribunal under sub-section (1) or sub-section (2) shall be dealt with by it as
expeditiously as possible and every effort shall be made by it to complete the proceedings in two hearings,
and to dispose of the application finally within one hundred and eighty days from the date of receipt of the
application.
(25) The Tribunal may make such orders and give such directions as may be necessary or expedient to give
effect to its orders or to prevent abuse of its process or to secure the ends of justice.
Filing of recovery applications, documents and written statements in electronic form (Section 19A)
(1) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Act, and without prejudice to the provisions
contained in section 6 of the Information Technology Act, 2000, the Central Government may by rules provide
that from such date and before such Tribunal and Appellate Tribunal, as may be notified, –
(a) application or written statement or any other pleadings and the documents to be annexed thereto
required to be filed shall be submitted in the electronic form and authenticated with digital signature of
the applicant, defendant or any other petitioner in such form and manner as may be prescribed;
(b) any summons, notice or communication or intimation as may be required to be served or delivered
under this Act, may be served or delivered by transmission of pleadings and documents by electronic
form and authenticated in such manner as may be prescribed.
(2) Any interim or final order passed by the Tribunal or Appellate Tribunal displayed on the website of such
Tribunal or Appellate Tribunal shall be deemed to be a public notice of such order and transmission of such
194 PP-IL&P
order by electronic mail to the registered address of the parties to the proceeding shall be deemed to be served
on such party.
(3) The Central Government may by rules provide that the electronic form for the purpose specified in this
section shall be exclusive, or in the alternative or in addition to the physical form, therefor.
(4) The Tribunal or the Appellate Tribunal notified under sub-section (1), for the purpose of adopting electronic
filing, shall maintain its own website or common website with other Tribunals and Appellate Tribunal or such
other universally accessible repositories of electronic information and ensure that all orders or directions issued
by the Tribunal or Appellate Tribunal are displayed on the website of the Tribunal or Appellate Tribunal, in such
manner as may be prescribed.
Explanation. – For the purpose of this section, –
(a) ‘digital signature’ means the digital signature as defined under clause (p) of section 2 of the Information
Technology Act, 2000 (21 of 2000);
(b) ‘electronic form’ with reference to an information or a document means the electronic form as defined
under clause (r) of section 2 of the Information Technology Act, 2000.
Limitations
Section 24 states that the provisions of the Limitation Act, 1963, shall, as far as may be, apply to an application
made to a Tribunal.
(a) attachment and sale of the movable or immovable property of the defendant;
(aa) taking possession of property over which security interest is created or any other property of the
defendant and appointing receiver for such property and to sell the same
(b) arrest of the defendant and his detention in prison;
(c) appointing a receiver for the management of the movable or immovable properties of the defendant;
[(d) any other mode of recovery as may be prescribed by the Central Government.
Officer shall, when the order which was the subject-matter of such appeal has become final and
conclusive, amend the certificate or withdraw it, as the case may be.
shall be personally liable to the Recovery Officer to the extent of his own liability to the defendant so discharged
or to the extent of the defendant’s liability for any debt due under this Act, whichever is less.
(ix) If the person to whom a notice under this sub-section is sent fails to make payment in pursuance thereof to
the Recovery Officer, he shall be deemed to be a defendant in default in respect of the amount specified in the
notice and further proceedings may be taken against him for the realisation of the amount as if it were a debt
due from him, in the manner provided in sections 25, 26 and 27 and the notice shall have the same effect as an
attachment of a debt by the Recovery Officer in exercise of his powers under section 25.
(4) The Recovery Officer may apply to the court in whose custody there is money belonging to the defendant
for payment to him of the entire amount of such money, or if it is more than the amount of debt due, an amount
sufficient to discharge the amount of debt so due.
(4A) The Recovery Officer may, by order, at any stage of the execution of the certificate of recovery, require any
person, and in case of a company, any of its officers against whom or which the certificate of recovery is issued,
to declare on affidavit the particulars of his or its assets.
(5) The Recovery Officer may recover any amount of debt due from the defendant by distraint and sale of his
movable property in the manner laid down in the Third Schedule to the Income-tax Act, 1961.
Deposit of amount of debt due for filing appeal against orders of the Recovery Officer
Section 30A states that where an appeal is preferred against any order of the Recovery Officer, under section
30, by any person from whom the amount of debt is due to a bank or financial institution or consortium of banks
or financial institutions, such appeal shall not be entertained by the Tribunal unless such person has deposited
with the Tribunal fifty per cent of the amount of debt due as determined by the Tribunal.
Provided that nothing in this sub-section shall apply to any appeal pending as aforesaid before any court:
Provided further that any recovery proceedings in relation to the recovery of debts due to any multi- State
co-operative bank pending before the date of commencement of the Enforcement of Security Interest and
Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 under the Multi-State Co-operative Societies Act, 2002, shall
be continued and nothing contained in this section shall apply to such proceedings.
(2) Where any suit or other proceeding stands transferred from any court to a Tribunal under sub- section (1), –
(a) the court shall, as soon as may be after such transfer, forward the records of such suit or other
proceeding to the Tribunal; and
(b) the Tribunal may, on receipt of such records, proceed to deal with such suit or other proceeding, so far
as may be, in the same manner as in the case of an application made under section 19 from the stage
which was reached before such transfer or from any earlier stage as the Tribunal may deem fit.
INTRODUCTION
Winding up is a means by which the dissolution of a company is brought about. The main purpose of winding up
of a company is to realize the assets and pay the company’s debts expeditiously and fairly in accordance with
the law. If any surplus is left, it is distributed among the members in accordance with their rights.
It may be noted that on winding up, the company does not cease to exist as such except when it is dissolved.
Even after commencement of the winding-up, the property and assets of the company belong to the company
until the dissolution takes place. On dissolution, the company ceases to exist as a separate entity and becomes
incapable of keeping property, suing or being sued. Thus in between the winding up and dissolution, the legal
status of the company continues and it can be sued in the court of law.
The terms “Winding up” and “Dissolution” are sometimes erroneously used to mean the same thing. But, the
legal implications of these two terms are quite different and there are fundamental differences between them as
regards the legal procedure involved.
The entire procedure for bringing about a lawful end to the life of a company is divided into two stages i.e.,
‘winding up’ and ‘dissolution’. Winding up is the first stage in the process whereby assets are realised, liabilities
are paid off and the surplus, if any, distributed among its members. Dissolution is the final stage whereby the
existence of the company is withdrawn by the law. Dissolution brings about an end to the legal entity of the
company.
Important Changes brought about by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 was passed with the objective of consolidating and amending the
laws relating to reorganisation and insolvency resolution in a time bound manner for maximization of value of
assets of such persons, to promote entrepreneurship, availability of credit and balance the interests of all the
stakeholders including alteration in the order of priority of payment of Government dues and to establish an
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India, and for other matters connected.
The Ministry of Corporate Affairs has notified section 255 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Section 255 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 amends the Companies Act, 2013, in accordance
with the Eleventh Schedule of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
The Central Government has appointed the 15 November, 2016 as the date on which the provisions of the
section 255 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 shall come into force.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 has made significant amendments to provisions relating to winding
up in the Companies Act, 2013. The important ones are discussed below:
“Winding up” – The expression “winding up” was not defined in the Companies Act, 2013 or in the erstwhile
Companies Act of 1956. The Eleventh Schedule has added sub-section (94A) to section 2 of the Companies
Act, 1956. The definition of “winding up” reads as follows:
201
202 PP-IL&P
“Winding up” means winding up under this Act or liquidation under the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016,
as applicable.” [Section 2(94A)]
Voluntary winding up – Provisions relating to voluntary winding up in the Companies Act, 2013 i.e., sections
304 to 323 have been omitted by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016. Voluntary liquidation is now dealt
with under section 59 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Inability to pay debts – Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 has substituted section 271 of the Companies
Act, 2013. Section 271 of the Companies Act, 2013, before its substitution by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code, 2016, provided the following seven grounds for winding up by Tribunal:
(a) if the company is unable to pay its debts;
(b) if the company has, by special resolution, resolved that the company be wound up by the Tribunal;
(c) if the company has acted against the interests of the sovereignty and integrity of India, the security of
the State, friendly relations with foreign States, public order, decency or morality;
(d) if the Tribunal has ordered the winding up of the company under Chapter XIX;
(e) if on an application made by the Registrar or any other person authorised by the Central Government
by notification under this Act, the Tribunal is of the opinion that the affairs of the company have been
conducted in a fraudulent manner or the company was formed for fraudulent and unlawful purpose
or the persons concerned in the formation or management of its affairs have been guilty of fraud,
misfeasance or misconduct in connection therewith and that it is proper that the company be wound up;
(f) if the company has made a default in filing with the Registrar its financial statements or annual returns
for immediately preceding five consecutive financial years; or
(g) if the Tribunal is of the opinion that it is just and equitable that the company should be wound up.
Now after its substitution, section 271 provides the following five grounds where a company may be wound up
by a Tribunal:
“(a) if the company has, by special resolution, resolved that the company be wound up by the Tribunal;
(b) if the company has acted against the interests of the sovereignty and integrity of India, the security of
the State, friendly relations with foreign States, public order, decency or morality;
(c) if on an application made by the Registrar or any other person authorised by the Central Government
by notification under this Act, the Tribunal is of the opinion that the affairs of the company have been
conducted in a fraudulent manner or the company was formed for fraudulent and unlawful purpose
or the persons concerned in the formation or management of its affairs have been guilty of fraud,
misfeasance or misconduct in connection therewith and that it is proper that the company be wound up;
(d) if the company has made a default in filing with the Registrar its financial statements or annual returns
for immediately preceding five consecutive financial years; or
(e) if the Tribunal is of the opinion that it is just and equitable that the company should be wound up.”
The following two grounds have been deleted from section 271:
“(a) if the company is unable to pay its debts;
(d) if the Tribunal has ordered the winding up of the company under Chapter XIX”
Thus, if a company is unable to pay its debts, creditors can’t file petition in tribunal in for winding up of the
Company. However, the Companies Act, 2013 shall continue to govern winding up of companies on various
other grounds excluding inability to pay debts.
Lesson 11 n Winding-up by Tribunal 203
Powers of Tribunal
According to section 273(1), the Tribunal may, on receipt of a petition for winding up under section 272 pass any
of the following orders, namely: –
(a) dismiss it, with or without costs;
(b) make any interim order as it thinks fit;
(c) appoint a provisional liquidator of the company till the making of a winding up order;
(d) make an order for the winding up of the company with or without costs; or
(e) any other order as it thinks fit:
204 PP-IL&P
Provided that an order under this sub-section shall be made within ninety days from the date of presentation of
the petition:
Provided further that before appointing a provisional liquidator under clause (c), the Tribunal shall give notice
to the company and afford a reasonable opportunity to it to make its representations, if any, unless for special
reasons to be recorded in writing, the Tribunal thinks fit to dispense with such notice:
Provided also that the Tribunal shall not refuse to make a winding up order on the ground only that the assets
of the company have been mortgaged for an amount equal to or in excess of those assets, or that the company
has no assets.
Where a petition is presented on the ground that it is just and equitable that the company should be wound up,
the Tribunal may refuse to make an order of winding up, if it is of the opinion that some other remedy is available
to the petitioners and that they are acting unreasonably in seeking to have the company wound up instead of
pursuing the other remedy. [Section 273(2)]
“Company Liquidator”, means a person appointed by the Tribunal as the Company Liquidator in accordance
with the provisions of section 275 for the winding up of a company under this Act. [Section 2(23)]
Liquidator, such liquidator shall, within sixty days from the order, submit to the Tribunal, a report containing the
following particulars, namely:
(a) the nature and details of the assets of the company including their location and value, stating separately
the cash balance in hand and in the bank, if any, and the negotiable securities, if any, held by the
company:
Provided that the valuation of the assets shall be obtained from registered valuers for this purpose;
(b) amount of capital issued, subscribed and paid-up;
(c) the existing and contingent liabilities of the company including names, addresses and occupations of
its creditors, stating separately the amount of secured and unsecured debts, and in the case of secured
debts, particulars of the securities given, whether by the company or an officer thereof, their value and
the dates on which they were given;
(d) the debts due to the company and the names, addresses and occupations of the persons from whom
they are due and the amount likely to be realised on account thereof;
(e) guarantees, if any, extended by the company;
(f) list of contributories and dues, if any, payable by them and details of any unpaid call;
(g) details of trademarks and intellectual properties, if any, owned by the company;
(h) details of subsisting contracts, joint ventures and collaborations, if any;
(i) details of holding and subsidiary companies, if any;
(j) details of legal cases filed by or against the company; and
(k) any other information which the Tribunal may direct or the Company Liquidator may consider necessary
to include.
The Company Liquidator shall include in his report the manner in which the company was promoted or formed
and whether in his opinion any fraud has been committed by any person in its promotion or formation or by any
officer of the company in relation to the company since the formation thereof and any other matters which, in
his opinion, it is desirable to bring to the notice of the Tribunal. [Section 281(2)]
The Company Liquidator shall also make a report on the viability of the business of the company or the steps
which, in his opinion, are necessary for maximising the value of the assets of the company. [Section 281(3)]
The Company Liquidator may also, if he thinks fit, make any further report or reports. [Section 281(4)]
Any person describing himself in writing to be a creditor or a contributory of the company shall be entitled by
himself or by his agent at all reasonable times to inspect the report submitted in accordance with this section
and take copies thereof or extracts therefrom on payment of the prescribed fees. [Section 281(5)]
The Tribunal may, on examination of the reports submitted to it by the Company Liquidator and after hearing the
Company Liquidator, creditors or contributories or any other interested person, order sale of the company as a
going concern or its assets or part thereof:
Provided that the Tribunal may, where it considers fit, appoint a sale committee comprising such creditors,
promoters and officers of the company as the Tribunal may decide to assist the Company Liquidator in sale
under this sub-section. [Section 282(2)]
Where a report is received from the Company Liquidator or the Central Government or any person that a fraud
has been committed in respect of the company, the Tribunal shall, without prejudice to the process of winding
up, order for investigation under section 210, and on consideration of the report of such investigation it may
pass order and give directions under sections 339 to 342 or direct the Company Liquidator to file a criminal
complaint against persons who were involved in the commission of fraud. [Section 282(3)]
The Tribunal may order for taking such steps and measures, as may be necessary, to protect, preserve or
enhance the value of the assets of the company. [Section 282(4)]
The Tribunal may pass such other order or give such other directions as it considers fit. [Section 282(5)]
Advisory Committee
The Tribunal may, while passing an order of winding up of a company, direct that there shall be, an advisory
committee to advise the Company Liquidator and to report to the Tribunal on such matters as the Tribunal may
direct. [Section 287(1)]
The advisory committee appointed by the Tribunal shall consist of not more than twelve members, being
creditors and contributories of the company or such other persons in such proportion as the Tribunal may,
keeping in view the circumstances of the company under liquidation, direct. [Section 287(2)]
The Company Liquidator shall convene a meeting of creditors and contributories, as ascertained from the books
and documents, of the company within thirty days from the date of order of winding up for enabling the Tribunal
to determine the persons who may be members of the advisory committee. [Section 287(3)]
The advisory committee shall have the right to inspect the books of account and other documents, assets and
properties of the company under liquidation at a reasonable time. [Section 287(4)]
The provisions relating to the convening of the meetings, the procedure to be followed thereat and other matters
relating to conduct of business by the advisory committee shall be such as may be prescribed. [Section 287(5)]
The meeting of advisory committee shall be chaired by the Company Liquidator. [Section 287(6)]
(b) to do all acts and to execute, in the name and on behalf of the company, all deeds, receipts and other
documents, and for that purpose, to use, when necessary, the company’s seal;
(c) to sell the immovable and movable property and actionable claims of the company by public auction
or private contract, with power to transfer such property to any person or body corporate, or to sell the
same in parcels;
(d) to sell the whole of the undertaking of the company as a going concern;
(e) to raise any money required on the security of the assets of the company;
(f) to institute or defend any suit, prosecution or other legal proceeding, civil or criminal, in the name and
on behalf of the company;
(g) to invite and settle claim of creditors, employees or any other claimant and distribute sale proceeds in
accordance with priorities established under this Act;
(h) to inspect the records and returns of the company on the files of the Registrar or any other authority;
(i) to prove rank and claim in the insolvency of any contributory for any balance against his estate, and
to receive dividends in the insolvency, in respect of that balance, as a separate debt due from the
insolvent, and rateably with the other separate creditors;
(j) to draw, accept, make and endorse any negotiable instruments including cheque, bill of exchange,
hundi or promissory note in the name and on behalf of the company, with the same effect with respect
to the liability of the company as if such instruments had been drawn, accepted, made or endorsed by
or on behalf of the company in the course of its business;
(k) to take out, in his official name, letters of administration to any deceased contributory, and to do in his
official name any other act necessary for obtaining payment of any money due from a contributory
or his estate which cannot be conveniently done in the name of the company, and in all such cases,
the money due shall, for the purpose of enabling the Company Liquidator to take out the letters of
administration or recover the money, be deemed to be due to the Company Liquidator himself;
(l) to obtain any professional assistance from any person or appoint any professional, in discharge of
his duties, obligations and responsibilities and for protection of the assets of the company, appoint an
agent to do any business which the Company Liquidator is unable to do himself;
(m) to take all such actions, steps, or to sign, execute and verify any paper, deed, document, application,
petition, affidavit, bond or instrument as may be necessary, –
(i) for winding up of the company;
(ii) for distribution of assets;
(iii) in discharge of his duties and obligations and functions as Company Liquidator; and
(n) to apply to the Tribunal for such orders or directions as may be necessary for the winding up of the
company.
(c) to the Central Government and any State Government, if both the Governments are members of the
Government company. [Section 294(5)]
The Company Liquidator shall cause the accounts when audited, or a summary thereof, to be printed, and shall
send a printed copy of the accounts or summary thereof by post to every creditor and every contributory:
Provided that the Tribunal may dispense with the compliance of the provisions of this sub-section in any case
it deems fit. [Section 294(6)]
(a) a person is indebted to the company, the Tribunal may order him to pay to the provisional liquidator or,
as the case may be, the liquidator at such time and in such manner as the Tribunal may consider just,
the amount in which he is indebted, or any part thereof, either in full discharge of the whole amount or
not, as the Tribunal thinks fit, with or without costs of the examination;
(b) a person is in possession of any property belonging to the company, the Tribunal may order him to
deliver to the provisional liquidator or, as the case may be, the liquidator, that property or any part
thereof, at such time, in such manner and on such terms as the Tribunal may consider just. [Section
299(5)]
If any officer or person so summoned fails to appear before the Tribunal at the time appointed without a
reasonable cause, the Tribunal may impose an appropriate cost. [Section 299(6)]
Every order made under sub-section (5) shall be executed in the same manner as decrees for the payment
of money or for the delivery of property under the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908 (5 of 1908). [Section 299(7)]
Any person making any payment or delivery in pursuance of an order made under sub-section (5) shall by such
payment or delivery be, unless otherwise directed by such order, discharged from all liability whatsoever in
respect of such debt or property. [Section 299(8)]
Fraudulent Preference
Section 328 of the Companies Act, 2013 deals with fraudulent preference. Sub-section (1) of section 328
provides that where a company has given preference to a person who is one of the creditors of the company
or a surety or guarantor for any of the debts or other liabilities of the company, and the company does anything
or suffers anything done which has the effect of putting that person into a position which, in the event of the
company going into liquidation, will be better than the position he would have been in if that thing had not been
done prior to six months of making winding up application, the Tribunal, if satisfied that, such transaction is a
fraudulent preference may order as it may think fit for restoring the position to what it would have been if the
company had not given that preference.
According to sub-section (2), if the Tribunal is satisfied that there is a preference transfer of property, movable or
immovable, or any delivery of goods, payment, execution made, taken or done by or against a company within
six months before making winding up application, the Tribunal may order as it may think fit and may declare
such transaction invalid and restore the position.
INTRODUCTION
Cross-border insolvency (sometimes called international insolvency) regulates the treatment of financially
distressed debtors where such debtors have assets or creditors in more than one country. In recent times, the
number of cross-border insolvency cases has increased significantly. The increasing frequency of cross-border
insolvencies reflects the continuing expansion of global trade and investment. However, national insolvency
laws are often ill-equipped to deal with cases of a cross-border nature and they have by and large not kept pace
with the trend. Fraud by insolvent debtors, in particular by concealing assets or transferring them to foreign
jurisdictions, is another increasing problem, in terms of both its frequency and its magnitude.
There is also a lack of communication and coordination among courts and administrators from concerned
jurisdictions. These deficiencies frequently results in inadequate and inharmonious legal approaches, which
hamper the rescue of financially troubled businesses. Such inadequate and uncoordinated legal approaches,
unconducive to a fair and efficient administration of cross-border insolvencies, impede the protection of the
assets of the insolvent debtor and affect the maximization of the value of those assets. Such approaches are
not only unpredictable and time-consuming in their application, but also lack transparency and the necessary
tools to address the issues. All these factors adversely affect the value of the assets of financially troubled
businesses and hampers their rescue. Moreover, the absence of predictability in the cross-border insolvency
processes impedes capital flow and is a disincentive to cross-border investment.
The organisation of insolvency proceedings with an international element is not an easy or straightforward matter.
Solutions to the phenomenon of cross-border insolvency are reliant on a number of complex and interrelated
questions to which the courts and legislatures in different jurisdictions have provided varying answers.
Cross-border insolvency problems are not limited to the failure of major international businesses. A domestic
business may have foreign branches or subsidiaries, or a foreign business may have domestic branches or
subsidiaries. Property located in a foreign country may provide security for a debt so that domestic assets can
be used to pay unsecured creditors. Foreign creditors may have valid claims in domestic bankruptcy cases,
and domestic creditors may have valid claims in foreign bankruptcy cases. Any one of these situations raises a
transnational insolvency problem.
The final negotiations on the draft legislative guide on insolvency law were held during the thirty-seventh session
of UNCITRAL in New York from 14 to 21 June 2004 and the text was adopted by consensus on 25 June 2004.
Subsequently, the General Assembly adopted resolution 59/40 of 2 December 2004 in which it expressed its
appreciation to UNCITRAL for completing and adopting the Legislative Guide.
Purpose
The purpose of the Legislative Guide on Insolvency Law is to assist the establishment of an efficient and
effective legal framework to address the financial difficulty of debtors. The Legislative Guide provides
a comprehensive statement of the key objectives and principles that should be reflected in a State’s
insolvency laws. It is intended to inform and assist insolvency law reform around the world, providing a
reference tool for national authorities and legislative bodies when preparing new laws and regulations
or reviewing the adequacy of existing laws and regulations. The advice provided aims at achieving a
balance between the need to address a debtor’s financial difficulty as quickly and efficiently as possible;
the interests of the various parties directly concerned with that financial difficulty, principally creditors and
other stakeholders in the debtor’s business; and public policy concerns, such as employment and taxation.
The Legislative Guide assists the reader to evaluate the different approaches and solutions available and
to choose the one most suitable to the local context.
Key Provisions
The Legislative Guide is divided into four parts.
Part one discusses the key objectives of an insolvency law, structural issues such as the relationship between
insolvency law and other law, the types of mechanisms available for resolving a debtor’s financial difficulties and
the institutional framework required to support an effective insolvency regime.
Part two deals with core features of an effective insolvency law, following as closely as possible the various
stages of an insolvency proceeding from their commencement to discharge of the debtor and closure of the
proceedings. Key elements are identified as including: standardized commencement criteria; a stay to protect
the assets of the insolvency estate that includes actions by secured creditors; post-commencement finance;
participation of creditors; provision for expedited reorganization proceedings; simplified requirements for
submission and verification of claims; conversion of reorganization to liquidation when reorganization fails; and
clear rules for discharge of the debtor and closure of insolvency proceedings.
Part three addresses the treatment of enterprise groups in insolvency, both nationally and internationally. While
many of the issues addressed in parts one and two are equally applicable to enterprise groups, there are that
only apply in the enterprise group context. Part three thus builds upon and supplements parts one and two. At
the domestic level, the commentary and recommendations of part three cover various mechanisms that can
be used to streamline insolvency proceedings involving two or more members of the same enterprise group.
These include: procedural coordination of multiple proceedings concerning different debtors; issues concerning
post-commencement and post-application finance in a group context; avoidance provisions; substantive
consolidation of insolvency proceedings affecting two or more group members; appointment of a single or the
same insolvency representative to all group members subject to insolvency; and coordinated reorganization
plans. In terms of the international treatment of groups, part three focuses on cooperation and coordination,
extending provisions based upon the Model Law on Cross-Border Insolvency to the group context and, as
appropriate, considering the applicability to the international context of the mechanisms proposed to address
enterprise group insolvencies in the national context.
Part four focuses on the obligations that might be imposed upon those responsible for making decisions with
respect to the management of an enterprise when that enterprise faces imminent insolvency or insolvency
becomes unavoidable. The aim of imposing such obligations, which are enforceable once insolvency proceedings
commence, is to protect the legitimate interests of creditors and other stakeholders and to provide incentives for
timely action to minimize the effects of financial distress experienced by the enterprise.
UNCITRAL Legislative Guide on Insolvency Law vis-a-vis UNCITRAL Model Law on Cross-
Border Insolvency
A model law generally is used differently than a legislative guide. Specifically, a model law is a legislative text
recommended to States for enactment as part of national law, with or without modification. As such, model laws
generally propose a comprehensive set of legislative solutions to address a particular topic and the language
employed supports direct incorporation of the provisions of the model law into a national law.
The focus of a legislative guide, on the other hand, is upon providing guidance to legislators and other users and
for that reason guides generally include a substantial commentary discussing and analysing relevant issues.
It is not intended that the recommendations of a legislative guide be enacted as part of national law as such.
Rather, they outline the core issues that it would be desirable to address in that law, with some recommendations
providing specific guidance on how certain legislative provisions might be drafted.
Lesson 12 n Cross Border Insolvency 217
Purpose
The UNCITRAL Model Law on Cross-Border Insolvency, adopted in 1997, is designed to assist States to equip
their insolvency laws with a modern, harmonized and fair framework to address more effectively instances of
cross-border insolvency. Those instances include cases where the insolvent debtor has assets in more than
one State or where some of the creditors of the debtor are not from the State where the insolvency proceeding
is taking place.
The Model Law is designed to assist States to equip their insolvency laws with a modern legal framework
to more effectively address cross-border insolvency proceedings concerning debtors experiencing severe
financial distress or insolvency. It focuses on authorizing and encouraging cooperation and coordination
between jurisdictions, rather than attempting the unification of substantive insolvency law, and respects the
differences among national procedural laws. For the purposes of the Model Law, a cross-border insolvency is
one where the insolvent debtor has assets in more than one State or where some of the creditors of the debtor
are not from the State where the insolvency proceeding is taking place.
The UNCITRAL Model Law has been adopted in as many as 44 countries and, therefore, forms part of
international best practices in dealing with cross border insolvency issues. The model law deals with four
major principles of cross-border insolvency, namely
• direct access to foreign insolvency professionals and foreign creditors to participate in or commence
domestic insolvency proceedings against a defaulting debtor;
• recognition of foreign proceedings & provision of remedies;
• cooperation between domestic and foreign courts & domestic and foreign insolvency practioners; and
• coordination between two or more concurrent insolvency proceedings in different countries. The main
proceeding is determined by the concept of centre of main interest (“COMI”).
Key Provisions
The Model Law focuses on four elements identified as key to the conduct of cross-border insolvency cases:
access, recognition, relief (assistance) and cooperation.
(a) Access
These provisions give representatives of foreign insolvency proceedings and creditors a right of access to
the courts of an enacting State to seek assistance and authorize representatives of local proceedings being
conducted in the enacting State to seek assistance elsewhere.
(b) Recognition
One of the key objectives of the Model Law is to establish simplified procedures for recognition of qualifying
foreign proceedings in order to avoid time-consuming legalization or other processes that often apply and to
provide certainty with respect to the decision to recognize. These core provisions accord recognition to orders
issued by foreign courts commencing qualifying foreign proceedings and appointing the foreign representative
of those proceedings. Provided it satisfies specified requirements, a qualifying foreign proceeding should be
recognized as either a main proceeding, taking place where the debtor had its centre of main interests at the
date of commencement of the foreign proceeding or a non-main proceeding, taking place where the debtor
has an establishment. Recognition of foreign proceedings under the Model Law has several effects - principal
amongst them is the relief accorded to assist the foreign proceeding.
(c) Relief
A basic principle of the Model Law is that the relief considered necessary for the orderly and fair conduct
of cross-border insolvencies should be available to assist foreign proceedings. By specifying the relief that
is available, the Model Law neither imports the consequences of foreign law into the insolvency system of
the enacting State nor applies to the foreign proceedings the relief that would be available under the law
of the enacting State. Key elements of the relief available include interim relief at the discretion of the court
between the making of an application for recognition and the decision on that application, an automatic stay
upon recognition of main proceedings and relief at the discretion of the court for both main and non-main
proceedings following recognition.
Scope of application
1. UNCITRAL Model Law on Cross-Border Insolvency applies where:
(a) Assistance is sought in this State by a foreign court or a foreign representative in connection with a
foreign proceeding; or
(b) Assistance is sought in a foreign State in connection with a proceeding under [identify laws of the
enacting State relating to insolvency]; or
(c) A foreign proceeding and a proceeding under [identify laws of the enacting State relating to insolvency]
in respect of the same debtor are taking place concurrently; or
(d) Creditors or other interested persons in a foreign State have an interest in requesting the commencement
of, or participating in, a proceeding under [identify laws of the enacting State relating to insolvency].
UNCITRAL Model Law on Cross-Border Insolvency does not apply to a proceeding concerning [designate any
types of entities, such as banks or insurance companies, that are subject to a special insolvency regime in this
State and that this State wishes to exclude from this Law]. [Article 1]
Interpretation
In the interpretation of Model Law, regard is to be had to its international origin and to the need to promote
uniformity in its application and the observance of good faith. [Article 8]
trustee sells all of its assets, under Chapter 11 the debtor remains in control of its business operations
and repay creditors concurrently through a court-approved reorganization plan.
• Chapter 12 was added to the Bankruptcy Code in 1986. It allows a family farmer or fisherman to
continue to operate the business while the plan is being carried out.
• Chapter 13 enables individuals with regular income to develop a plan to repay all or part of their debts.
• Chapter15 was added to the Bankruptcy Code in 2005. It provides mechanism for dealing with
insolvency cases involving debtors, claimants and other interested parties involving more than one
country. Under Chapter 15 a representative of a corporate bankruptcy proceeding outside the country
can get access to the United States courts.
Chapter 11 Reorganization
American bankruptcy procedures enable sick Companies to restructure its debt obligations even while remaining
operational. In this context, one must recognise that in the US the wellknown Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings
are considered as re-organization/ resurrection process for corporates. Many companies are known to have
revived under Chapter 11. Further, Chapter 11 ensures the emergence of companies with sustainable debt
levels and profitable working. Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings are available to every business, whether
organized as a corporation, partnership or sole proprietorship, and to individuals, although it is most prominently
used by corporate entities.
Chapter 11 consists of sections 1101 to 1174 and is divided into following four sub-chapters:
• Sub-chapter I – Officer and administration (Sections 1101 to 1116)
• Sub-chapter II – The plan (Sections 1121 to 1129)
• Sub-chapter III – Post confirmation matters (Sections 1141 to 1146)
• Sub-chapter IV – Railroad reorganization (Sections 1161 to 1174)
One of the most remarkable events in recent business history has been the decision of General Motors
Corporation USA to file bankruptcy proceedings — a decision forced on the company after it lost market share
in the ongoing recession. Its assets were significantly lower than its liabilities. It has emerged from 40 days
bankruptcy protection after creating a “new GM” made up of the best assets with fewer brand, fewer employees,
etc. For that matter, Chapter 11 could even recover WorldCom which emerged from bankruptcy as MCI during
2004.
Section 363 under Chapter 11 of US Bankruptcy law is an established procedure which enables companies to
sell assets free of debts and encumbrances to preserve the value of the enterprise. A company under Chapter
11 can choose to sell off particular assets. A bankrupt company, the “debtor,” might use this Code to “reorganize”
its business and become profitable again.
The key to a successful Chapter 11 case is the continued operation of the debtor’s business. In addition to
running the business, the debtor or the trustee must fulfil additional duties required by the Bankruptcy Code and
work with creditors, the court, and other parties to obtain financing for ongoing business operations.
• Management remains in control of the business during the chapter 11 rehabilitative process. Trustees,
administrators and monitors typically are not appointed.
• Chapter 11 normally does not cause interruption to business operations.
• The company is given breathing room during the process - an “automatic stay” generally prevents
parties from taking legal action against the company or taking the company’s assets.
• Most publicly-held companies prefer to file under Chapter 11 rather than Chapter 7 because they
can still run their business and control the bankruptcy process. Chapter 11 provides a process for
rehabilitating the business of the company.
Sometimes the company successfully works out a plan to return to profitability; sometimes, in the end, it
liquidates. Under Chapter 11 reorganization, a company usually keeps doing business and its stock and bonds
may continue to trade in securities markets.
The U.S. Trustee, the bankruptcy arm of the Department of Justice, appoints one or more committees to represent
the interests of creditors and stockholders in working with the company to develop a plan of reorganization to
enable it to get out of debt. The plan must be accepted by the creditors, bondholders, and stockholders, and
confirmed by the court. However, even if creditors or stockholders vote aginst the plan, the court can disregard
the vote and still confirm the plan if it finds that the plan treats creditors and stockholders fairly.
Committees of creditors and stockholders negotiate a plan with the company to relieve the company from
repaying part of its debt so that the company is able to get back to its normal condition.
After the committees work with the company to develop a plan, the bankruptcy court must find that it legally
complies with the Bankruptcy Code before the plan can be implemented.
Thus, Chapter 11 bankruptcy involves a reorganization plan that accommodates debt reorganization through
a payment plan and the major advantage is that the debtors generally remain in possession of their property
and operate their business under the supervision of Court. Chapter 11 debtors also often keep a substantial
portion of their assets. The provisions of Chapter 11 allow the debtor, relief from pending obligations and the
opportunity to reorganize its business and restructure debts while continuing to operate the business. Under
this chapter a company can choose to sell off particular assets. Accordingly, subsidiaries outside US need not
be included in the Chapter 11 filings.
There is therefore no change in the legal status of its subsidiaries that are kept out of Chapter 11 filings. Further,
Debtors Audit, Debtors Counselling, Mandatory debtor education, etc. are provided under US Bankruptcy laws
which help in minimizing the fraudulent bankruptcies. In the light of the above, a need is felt to have similar
legal framework in India which allows continuity of business during bankruptcy proceedings, control over the
management of company filing bankruptcy application, keeping subsidiaries / certain assets outside the purview
of bankruptcy application, etc. in line with Chapter 11 of US Bankruptcy Code.
Enabling provisions for cross border transactions under Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016
Sections 234 and 235 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 make provisions to deal with cases
involving cross border insolvency.
Agreements with foreign countries – Section 234 empowers the central government to enter into an
agreement with other countries to resolve situations pertaining to cross border insolvency. Section 234 of the
Code provides that:
The Central Government may enter into an agreement with the Government of any country outside India for
enforcing the provisions of this Code. [Section 234(1)]
The Central Government may, by notification in the Official Gazette, direct that the application of provisions
222 PP-IL&P
of this Code in relation to assets or property of corporate debtor or debtor, including a personal guarantor of
a corporate debtor, as the case may be, situated at any place in a country outside India with which reciprocal
arrangements have been made, shall be subject to such conditions as may be specified. [Section 234(2)]
Letter of request to a country outside India in certain cases – Section 235 of the Code lays down that
notwithstanding anything contained in this Code or any law for the time being in force if, in the course of
insolvency resolution process, or liquidation or bankruptcy proceedings, as the case may be, under this Code,
the resolution professional, liquidator or bankruptcy trustee, as the case may be, is of the opinion that assets of
the corporate debtor or debtor, including a personal guarantor of a corporate debtor, are situated in a country
outside India with which reciprocal arrangements have been made under section 234, he may make an
application to the Adjudicating Authority that evidence or action relating to such assets is required in connection
with such process or proceeding. [Section 235(1)]
The Adjudicating Authority on receipt of an application under sub-section (1) and, on being satisfied that
evidence or action relating to assets under sub-section (1) is required in connection with insolvency resolution
process or liquidation or bankruptcy proceeding, may issue a letter of request to a court or an authority of such
country competent to deal with such request. [Section 235(2)]
The current cross border insolvency framework in India is dependant on India entering bilateral agreements
with other countries. Finalisation of bilateral agreements is a long drawn process as it involves long term
negotiations and thus takes a lot of time. Moreover, every trade is distinct and thus it would be difficult for the
adjudicating authorities to enforce the agreements/treaties entered into with other countries.
Lesson 13
Insolvency Resolution of Individual and
Partnership Firms
Introduction
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (Code) aims to consolidate laws relating to liquidation and
insolvency of corporate persons, partnership firms and individuals in India. The provisions of the Code aim to
maximize the value of assets of such persons in order to promote entrepreneurship in the country and also
increase the availability of capital and credit in the economy.
This Lesson envisage how debtor or creditor either on their own or through Resolution Professional can instigate
insolvency resolution process, role of a Resolution Professional since filing of application till finalization of
repayment plan and issuance of discharge order by Debt Recovery Tribunal and effect(s) upon the declaration
of interim moratorium and moratorium by Debt Recovery Tribunal. The Adjudicating Authority for dealing with
insolvency and bankruptcy of individual and partnership firm is Debt Recovery Tribunal and Appellate Authority
for the same is Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunal. Since the provisions related to insolvency resolution of
individual and partnership firm have not been notified under the Code therefore no statutory regulations providing
the form and manner for initiating insolvency resolution process have been notified yet by the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Board of India.
223
224 PP-IL&P
a) an undischarged bankrupt;
b) undergoing a fresh start process;
c) undergoing an insolvency resolution process; or
d) undergoing a bankruptcy process.
A debtor shall not be eligible to apply for insolvency resolution process if an application regarding insolvency
resolution process has already been admitted in respect of the debtor during the period of twelve months
preceding the date of submission of the application under this Section.
Interim Moratorium
Section 96 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that when an application for initiating the
insolvency resolution process is filed under Section 94 or Section 95 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code,
2016 then an interim-moratorium shall commence on the date of the application in relation to all the
debts and shall cease to have effect on the date of admission of such application.
During the interim-moratorium period any pending legal action or proceeding in respect of any debt shall be
deemed to have been stayed and the creditors of the debtor shall not initiate any legal action or proceedings in
respect of any debt.
Where the application for initiating the insolvency resolution process has been made in relation to a firm, the
interim moratorium shall operate against all the partners of the firm as on the date of the application. The
provisions of this Section shall not apply to such transactions as may be notified by the Central Government in
consultation with any financial sector regulator.
pending against the Resolution Professional. The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India shall within seven
days from the date of receipt of directions from Adjudicating Authority; communicate to the Adjudicating Authority
in writing either confirming the appointment of the Resolution Professional or rejecting the appointment
of the Resolution Professional and nominating another Resolution Professional for the insolvency
resolution process.
Where an application for initiating the insolvency resolution process under Section 94 or 95 of the Insolvency
and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 is filed by the debtor or the creditor himself (as the case may be) and not through
the Resolution Professional, the Adjudicating Authority shall direct the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of
India within seven days of the filing of such application, to nominate a Resolution Professional for the insolvency
resolution process.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India shall nominate a Resolution Professional within ten days of
receiving the direction from the Adjudicating Authority. The Adjudicating Authority shall by an order appoint the
Resolution Professional recommended or as nominated by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India. The
Resolution Professional appointed by the Adjudicating Authority shall be provided a copy of the application for
insolvency resolution process.
the appointment and submit a report to the Adjudicating Authority recommending for approval or rejection of the
application with regard to the initiation of insolvency resolution process.
Where the application has been filed under Section 95, the Resolution Professional may require the debtor to
prove repayment of the debt claimed as unpaid by the creditor by furnishing:
a) evidence of electronic transfer of the unpaid amount from the bank account of the debtor;
b) evidence of encashment of a cheque issued by the debtor; or
c) a signed acknowledgment by the creditor accepting receipt of dues.
Where the debt for which an application has been filed by a creditor is registered with the information utility, the
debtor shall not be entitled to dispute the validity of such debt.
Information Utility means a person who is registered with the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India as an
information utility under Section 210 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
For the purposes of examining the application with regard to the initiation of insolvency resolution process, the
Resolution Professional may seek such further information or explanation in connection with the application
as may be required from the debtor or the creditor or any other person who in the opinion of the Resolution
Professional may provide such information.
The person from whom such information or explanation is sought shall furnish such information or explanation
within seven days from the date of receipt of the request from Resolution Professional. The Resolution
Professional shall examine the application and ascertain that:
a) The application satisfies the requirements prescribed under Section 94 or 95 and
b) The applicant has provided information and given explanation sought by the Resolution Professional.
After examination of the application, Resolution Professional may recommend the acceptance or rejection
of the application in his report. Where the Resolution Professional finds that the debtor is eligible for a fresh
start Process (Section 81 to 93 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the Resolution Professional
shall submit a report recommending that the application by the debtor under Section 94 of the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016 be treated as an application under Section 81 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code,
2016 by the Adjudicating Authority.
The Resolution Professional shall record the reasons for recommending the acceptance or rejection of the
application in the report and shall give a copy of the report to the debtor or the creditor (as the case may be).
Professional or that the application was made with the intention to defraud his creditors or the Resolution
Professional, the order passed by Adjudicating Authority shall record that the creditor is entitled to file for the
Bankruptcy Order (Section 121 to 148 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Moratorium
Section 101 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that when the application for initiating
insolvency resolution process is admitted under Section 100 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016;
a moratorium shall commence in relation to all the debts and shall cease to have effect at the end of the
period of one hundred and eighty days beginning with the date of admission of the application or on the date
the Adjudicating Authority passes an order on the repayment plan under Section 114 of the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016 whichever is earlier.
During the moratorium period:
a) any pending legal action or proceeding in respect of any debt shall be deemed to have been stayed;
b) the creditors shall not initiate any legal action or legal proceedings in respect of any debt; and
c) the debtor shall not transfer, alienate, encumber or dispose of any of the assets or his legal right or
beneficial interest therein;
Where an order admitting the application for initiating insolvency resolution process under Section 96 of the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 has been made in relation to a firm, the moratorium shall operate
against all the partners of the firm. The provisions of this Section shall not apply to such transactions as may be
notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial sector regulator.
b) claims received by the Resolution Professional under Section 102 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code, 2016 .
The Resolution Professional shall prepare the list of creditors within thirty days from the date of the issue of the
notice by Adjudicating Authority
Repayment Plan
Section 105 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the debtor shall in consultation with the
Resolution Professional shall prepare a repayment plan containing a proposal to the creditors for restructuring
of the debts or affairs of the concerned debtor.
The repayment plan may authorise or require the Resolution Professional to:
a) carry on the debtor’s business or trade on his behalf or in his name; or
b) realise the assets of the debtor; or
c) administer or dispose of any funds of the debtor.
The repayment plan shall include the justification for preparation of such repayment plan and reasons on the
basis of which the creditors may agree upon the plan; provision for payment of fee to the Resolution Professional
and such other matters as may be specified.
Discharge Order
Section 119 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that on the basis of the repayment plan, the
Resolution Professional shall apply to the Adjudicating Authority for a discharge order in relation to the debts
mentioned in the repayment plan and the Adjudicating Authority may pass such discharge order.
232 PP-IL&P
The repayment plan may provide for early discharge or for discharge on complete implementation of the
repayment plan.
The discharge order shall be forwarded to the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India, for the purpose of
recording entries in the register referred to in Section 196 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.The
discharge order under shall not discharge any other person from any liability in respect of his debt.
Standard of Conduct
Section 120 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the Resolution Professional shall
perform his functions and duties in compliance with the Code of Conduct provided under Section 208 of the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Lesson 14
Bankruptcy Order for Individual and
Partnership Firms
Introduction
Bankruptcy is a legal procedure to give debt relief for people whose circumstances are unlikely to change
and who have no hope of paying off their debts within a reasonable time. The term bankruptcy applies only
to individuals and not to the companies or other legal entities. An individual may be made bankrupt only by
court order following the presentation of a bankruptcy petition. An individual may present his own petition on the
ground that he is insolvent, i.e. unable to pay his debts.
Chapter IV of Part III of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 deals with the provisions of bankruptcy
order for individuals and partnership firms. This Chapter explains how a debtor or creditor can apply for the
bankruptcy order and under what circumstances.
The Adjudicating Authority for dealing with insolvency and bankruptcy of individual and partnership firm is
Debt Recovery Tribunal and Appellate Authority for the same is Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunal. Since the
provisions related to insolvency resolution of individual and partnership firm have not been notified under the
Code therefore no statutory regulations providing the form and manner for initiating insolvency resolution
process have been notified yet by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
Application by debtor
Section 122 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that an application for bankruptcy of a
debtor shall be accompanied by:
a) the records of insolvency resolution process undertaken under Chapter III of Part III;
b) the statement of affairs of the debtor in such form and manner as may be prescribed, on the date of the
application for bankruptcy; and
c) a copy of the order passed by the Adjudicating Authority under Chapter III of Part III permitting the
debtor to apply for bankruptcy.
The debtor may propose an insolvency professional as the bankruptcy trustee in the application for bankruptcy.
An application for bankruptcy by the debtor shall not be withdrawn without the leave of the Adjudicating Authority.
233
234 PP-IL&P
Application by creditor
Section 123 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that an application for bankruptcy by a
creditor shall be accompanied by:
(a) the records of insolvency resolution process undertaken under Chapter III of the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016;
(b) a copy of the order passed by the Adjudicating Authority under Chapter III of the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016 permitting the creditor to apply for bankruptcy;
(c) details of the debts owed by the debtor to the creditor as on the date of the application for bankruptcy;
and
(d) such other information as may be prescribed.
An application made in respect of a debt which is secured shall be accompanied with:
(a) a statement by the creditor having the right to enforce the security that creditor shall in the event of a
bankruptcy order being made, give up his security for the benefit of all the creditors of the bankrupt; or
(b) a statement by the creditor stating that the application for bankruptcy is only in respect of the unsecured
part of the debt and an estimated value of the unsecured part of the debt.
If a secured creditor makes an application for bankruptcy and submits a statement, the secured and unsecured
parts of the debt shall be treated as separate debts. The creditor may propose an insolvency professional as
the bankruptcy trustee in the application for bankruptcy.
An application for bankruptcy in case of a deceased debtor, may be filed against his legal representatives.
The application for bankruptcy shall be in such form and manner and accompanied by such fee as may be
prescribed. An application for bankruptcy by the creditor shall not be withdrawn without the permission of the
Adjudicating Authority.
Effect of application
Section 124 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that when an application for bankruptcy is
filed under Section 122 or Section 123 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 then
a) interim-moratorium shall commence on the date of the making of the application on all actions against
the properties of the debtor in respect of his debts and such moratorium shall cease to have effect on
the bankruptcy commencement date; and
b) during the interim-moratorium period any pending legal action or legal proceeding against any property
of the debtor in respect of any of his debts shall be deemed to have been stayed and the creditors of
the debtor shall not be entitled to initiate any legal action or legal proceedings against any property of
the debtor in respect of any of his debts.
Where the application has been made in relation to a firm, the interim moratorium shall operate against all the
partners of the firm as on the date of the making of the application. The provisions of this Section shall not apply
to such transactions as may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial sector
regulator.
proceedings against such professional. The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India shall within ten days
from the date of the receipt of the direction shall in writing either confirm the appointment of the proposed
insolvency professional as the bankruptcy trustee for the bankruptcy process; or reject the appointment of the
proposed insolvency professional as the bankruptcy trustee and nominate another bankruptcy trustee for the
bankruptcy process.
Where a bankruptcy trustee is not proposed by the debtor or creditor under Section 122 or Section 123 of the
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (31 of 2016), the Adjudicating Authority shall direct the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Board of India within seven days of receiving the application to nominate a bankruptcy trustee for
the bankruptcy process. The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India shall nominate a bankruptcy trustee
within ten days of receiving the direction from the Adjudicating Authority. The bankruptcy trustee confirmed or
nominated under this Section shall be appointed as the bankruptcy trustee by the Adjudicating Authority in the
bankruptcy order under Section 126 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Bankruptcy Order
Section 126 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the Adjudicating Authority shall pass
a bankruptcy order within fourteen days of receiving the confirmation or nomination of the bankruptcy trustee
under Section 125 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016. The Adjudicating Authority shall provide to the
bankrupt, creditors and the bankruptcy trustee within seven days of the passing of the bankruptcy order, namely
a copy of the application for bankruptcy and a copy of the bankruptcy order.
Registration of claims
Section 131 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the creditors shall register claims with
the bankruptcy trustee within seven days of the publication of the public notice, by sending details of the claims
to the bankruptcy trustee in such manner as may be prescribed. The creditor in addition to the details of his
claims shall provide such other information and in such manner as may be prescribed.
Completion of administration
Section 137 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the bankruptcy trustee shall convene
a meeting of the committee of creditors on completion of the administration and distribution of the estate of
the bankrupt in accordance with the provisions of Chapter V (Voluntary Liquidation) of the Insolvency and
Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
The bankruptcy trustee shall provide the committee of creditors with a report of the administration of the estate
of the bankrupt in the meeting of the said committee. The committee of creditors shall approve the report
238 PP-IL&P
submitted by the bankruptcy trustee within seven days of the receipt of the report and determine whether the
bankruptcy trustee should be released under Section 148 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 .
The bankruptcy trustee shall retain sufficient sums from the estate of the bankrupt to meet the expenses of
convening and conducting the meeting required under this Section during the administration of the estate.
Discharge Order
Section 138 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the bankruptcy trustee shall apply to
the Adjudicating Authority for a discharge order on the expiry of one year from the bankruptcy commencement
date or within seven days of the approval of the committee of creditors of the completion of administration of
the estates of the bankrupt under Section 137 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.The Adjudicating
Authority shall pass a discharge order on an application by the bankruptcy trustee. A copy of the discharge order
shall be provided to the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India, for the purpose of recording an entry in the
register referred to in Section 196 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Effect of discharge
Section 139 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the discharge order under Section 138
of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 shall release the bankrupt from all the bankruptcy debts.
Provided that a discharge shall not:
a) affect the functions of the bankruptcy trustee; or
b) affect the operation of the provisions of Chapter IV and V of Part III of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Code, 2016.
c) release the bankrupt from any debt incurred by means of fraud or breach of trust to which he was a
party; or
d) discharge the bankrupt from any excluded debt.
Disqualification of bankrupt
Section 140 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the bankrupt shall from the bankruptcy
commencement date, be subject to the disqualifications mentioned in this Section. In addition to any
disqualification under any other law for the time being in force, a bankrupt shall be disqualified from:
a) being appointed or acting as a trustee or representative in respect of any trust, estate or settlement;
b) being appointed or acting as a public servant;
c) being elected to any public office where the appointment to such office is by election; and
d) being elected or sitting or voting as a member of any local authority.
Any disqualification to which a bankrupt may be subject under this Section shall cease to have effect, if the
bankruptcy order against him is modified or recalled under Section 142 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code,
or he is discharged under Section 138 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Explanation. - For the purposes of this Section, the term “public servant” shall have the same meaning as
assigned to it under Section 21 of the Indian Penal Code, 1860 .
Restrictions on bankrupt
Section 141 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that a bankrupt from the bankruptcy
commencement date shall:
Lesson 14 n Bankruptcy Order for Individual and Partnership Firms 239
a) not act as a director of any company, or directly or indirectly take part in or be concerned in the promotion,
formation or management of a company;
b) without the previous sanction of the bankruptcy trustee, be prohibited from creating any charge on his
estate or taking any further debt;
c) be required to inform his business partners that he is undergoing a bankruptcy process;
d) prior to entering into any financial or commercial transaction of such value as may be prescribed,
either individually or jointly, inform all the parties involved in such transaction that he is undergoing a
bankruptcy process;
e) without the previous sanction of the Adjudicating Authority, be incompetent to maintain any legal action
or proceedings in relation to the bankruptcy debts; and
f) not be permitted to travel overseas without the permission of the Adjudicating Authority.
Any restriction to which a bankrupt may be subject under this Section shall cease to have effect if the bankruptcy
order against him is modified or recalled under Section 142 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (31 of
2016) or he is discharged under Section 138 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Standard of conduct
Section 143 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the bankruptcy trustee shall perform
his functions and duties in compliance with the code of conduct provided under Section 208 of the Insolvency
and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Authority shall direct the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India for replacement of a bankruptcy trustee.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India shall within ten days of the direction of the Adjudicating Authority
recommend a bankruptcy trustee as a replacement.
The Adjudicating Authority shall appoint the bankruptcy trustee recommended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy
Board within fourteen days of receiving the recommendation. The earlier bankruptcy trustee shall deliver
possession of the estate of the bankrupt to the bankruptcy trustee appointed, on the date of his appointment.
The Adjudicating Authority may give directions to the bankruptcy trustee who has vacated the office to share
all information with the new bankruptcy trustee in respect of the bankruptcy and to co-operate with the new
bankruptcy trustee in such matters as may be required. The bankruptcy trustee appointed shall give a notice
of his appointment to the committee of creditors and the bankrupt within seven days of his appointment. The
earlier bankruptcy trustee replaced under this Section shall be released in accordance with the provisions of
Section 148 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
Provided that this Section shall not apply if the vacancy has occurred due to temporary illness or temporary
leave of the bankruptcy trustee.
Introduction
According to the Report of the Bankruptcy Law Reforms Committee, Volume I Rational and Design (November
2015)- A sound bankruptcy and insolvency framework requires the existence of an impartial, efficient and
expeditious administration. This is more likely to be possible for individual insolvency when administrative
proceedings are placed outside the court of law. As with legal entities, what is visualised for individuals is to
enable a negotiated settlement between creditors and debtor without active involvement of the court. The
principle is to allow greater flexibility in the repayment plans, and a time to execute the plans, that can be
acceptable to both parties. If creditors and debtors can settle on such a plan out of court, what matters for the
system is that there is a record of this settlement and that it can affect the premium of future credit transactions.
Economies across the world are increasingly placing administrative proceedings outside of the courts. This
seems to be a natural way forward for India as well.
Before enactment of Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, Personal insolvency is primarily governed under
two Acts in India: the Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909 (for the erstwhile Presidency towns, i.e. Kolkata,
Mumbai and Chennai) and the Provincial Insolvency Act, 1920 (for the rest of India). Though these are central
laws, it should be noted that both these Acts have a number of state specific amendments. The substantive
provisions under the two Acts are largely similar. There have not been any substantial changes to this regime
over the years and it has proved to be largely ineffective in practice.
In 2016, Parliament enacted Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code. The law aims to consolidate the laws relating to
insolvency of companies and limited liability entities (including limited liability partnerships and other entities with
limited liability), unlimited liability partnerships and individuals, presently contained in a number of legislations,
into a single legislation.
243
244 PP-IL&P
Estate of Bankrupt
According to Section 155(1) of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the estate of the bankrupt shall
include, –
(a) all property belonging to or vested in the bankrupt at the bankruptcy commencement date;
(b) the capacity to exercise and to initiate proceedings for exercising all such powers in or over or in
respect of property as might have been exercised by the bankrupt for his own benefit at the bankruptcy
commencement date or before the date of the discharge order passed under section 138; and
(c) all property which by virtue of any of the provisions of this Chapter is comprised in the estate.
Further as per Section 155(1) of the Code the estate of the bankrupt shall not include –
(a) excluded assets;
(b) property held by the bankrupt on trust for any other person;
246 PP-IL&P
(c) all sums due to any workman or employee from the provident fund, the pension fund and the gratuity
fund; and
(d) such assets as may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial sector
regulator.
the knowledge of the successor of the bankruptcy trustee at the same time; and
(b) anything which comes to the knowledge of a person before he is appointed as
a bankruptcy trustee shall be deemed to have come to his knowledge on the date of his appointment
as bankruptcy trustee.
(5) The bankruptcy trustee shall not be entitled, by virtue of this section, to claim from any person who
has acquired any right over after-acquired property, in good faith, for value and without notice of the
bankruptcy.
(6) A notice may be served after the expiry of the period under sub-section (3) only with the approval of the
Adjudicating Authority.
Explanation. – For the purposes of this section, the term “after-acquired property” means any property which
has been acquired by or has devolved upon the bankrupt after the bankruptcy commencement date.
(b) a decision under clause (a) has not been taken by the bankruptcy trustee within seven days of receipt
of the notice.
As per Section 161(2) of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, any onerous property which cannot be
disclaimed under sub-section (1) shall be deemed to be part of the estate of the bankrupt.
An onerous property is said to be disclaimed where notice in relation to that property has been given by the
bankruptcy trustee under section 160.
Disclaimer of Leaseholds
According to Section 162 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the bankruptcy trustee shall not be
entitled to disclaim any leasehold interest, unless a notice of disclaimer has been served on every interested
person and –
(a) no application objecting to the disclaimer by the interested person, has been filed with respect to the
leasehold interest, within fourteen days of the date on which notice was served; and
(b) where the application objecting to the disclaimer has been filed by the interested person, the Adjudicating
Authority has directed under section 163 that the disclaimer shall take effect.
Where the Adjudicating Authority gives a direction above, it may also make order with respect to fixtures,
improvements by tenant and other matters arising out of the lease as it may think fit.
Undervalued Transactions
As per Section 164(1) of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the bankruptcy trustee may apply to
the Adjudicating Authority for an order under this section in respect of an undervalued transaction between a
bankrupt and any person
As per Section 164(2) of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the undervalued transaction referred
Lesson 15 n Bankruptcy for Individuals and Partnership Firms 249
(c) pass any other order it thinks fit for restoring the position to what it would have been if the bankrupt
had not entered into the transaction giving preference.
(6) The Adjudicating Authority shall not pass an order under sub-section (5) unless the bankrupt was
influenced in his decision of giving preference to a person by a desire to produce in relation to that
person an effect under clause (b) of sub-section (8).
(7) For the purpose of sub-section (6), if the person is an associate of the bankrupt, (otherwise than by
reason only of being his employee), at the time when the preference was given, it shall be presumed
that the bankrupt was influenced in his decision under that sub- section.
(8) For the purposes of this section, a bankrupt shall be deemed to have entered into a transaction giving
preference to any person if –
a. the person is the creditor or surety or guarantor for any debt of the bankrupt; and
b. the bankrupt does anything or suffers anything to be done which has the effect of putting that
person into a position which, in the event of the debtor becoming a bankrupt, will be better than
the position he would have been in, if that thing had not been done.
Proof of debt
As per Section 171 of the Code the bankruptcy trustee shall give notice to each of the creditors to submit proof
of debt within fourteen days of preparing the list of creditors under section 132.
The proof of debt shall –
(a) require the creditor to give full particulars of debt, including the date on which the debt was contracted
and the value at which that person assesses it;
(b) require the creditor to give full particulars of the security, including the date on which the security was
given and the value at which that person assesses it;
(c) be in such form and manner as may be prescribed.
In case the creditor is a decree holder against the bankrupt, a copy of the decree shall be a valid proof of debt.
Where a debt bears interest, that interest shall be provable as part of the debt except in so far as it is owed in
respect of any period after the bankruptcy commencement date.
The bankruptcy trustee shall estimate the value of any bankruptcy debt which does not have a specific value.
The value assigned by the bankruptcy trustee shall be the amount provable by the concerned creditor.
A creditor may prove for a debt where payment would have become due at a date later than the bankruptcy
commencement date as if it were owed presently and may receive dividends in a manner as may be prescribed.
Where the bankruptcy trustee serves a notice and the person on whom the notice is served does not file a proof
of security within thirty days after the date of service of the notice, the bankruptcy trustee may, with leave of
the Adjudicating Authority, sell or dispose of any property that was subject to the security, free of that security.
Distribution of property
According to Section 175(1) of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016, the bankruptcy trustee may, with
the approval of the committee of creditors, divide in its existing form amongst the creditors, according to its
estimated value, any property in its existing form which from its peculiar nature or other special circumstances
cannot be readily or advantageously sold.
Section 175(2) provides that an approval under sub-section (1) shall be sought by the bankruptcy trustee for
each transaction, and a person dealing with the bankruptcy trustee in good faith and for value shall not be
required to enquire whether any approval required under sub-section (1) has been given.
Section 175(3) provides that where the bankruptcy trustee has done anything without the approval of the
committee of creditors, the committee may, for the purpose of enabling him to meet his expenses out of
the estate of the bankrupt, ratify the act of the bankruptcy trustee.
Section 175(4) states that the committee of the creditors shall not ratify the act of the bankruptcy trustee under
Section 175(3) unless it is satisfied that the bankruptcy trustee acted in a case of urgency and has sought its
ratification without undue delay.
(5) If a surplus remains after payment in full with interest to all the creditors of the bankrupt and the payment of
the expenses of the bankruptcy, the bankrupt shall be entitled to the surplus.
(6) Where a bankruptcy order has been passed in respect of one partner in a firm, a creditor to whom the
bankrupt is indebted jointly with the other partners in the firm or any of them shall not receive any dividend out
of the separate property of the bankrupt until all the separate creditors have received the full amount of their
respective debts.
bankrupt is insufficient to meet them, in which case they shall abate in equal proportions between themselves.
(3) Where any creditor has given any indemnity or has made any payment of moneys by virtue of which
any asset of the bankrupt has been recovered, protected or preserved, the Adjudicating Authority may make
such order as it thinks just with respect to the distribution of such asset with a view to giving that creditor an
advantage over other creditors in consideration of the risks taken by him in so doing.
(4) Unsecured creditors shall rank equally amongst themselves unless contractually agreed to the contrary by
such creditors.
(5) Any surplus remaining after the payment of the debts under sub-section (1) shall be applied in paying
interest on those debts in respect of the periods during which they have been outstanding since the bankruptcy
commencement date.
(6) Interest payments under sub-section (5) shall rank equally irrespective of the nature of the debt.
(7) In the case of partners, the partnership property shall be applicable in the first instance in payment of the
partnership debts and the separate property of each partner shall be applicable in the first instance in payment
of his separate debts.
(8) Where there is a surplus of the separate property of the partners, it shall be dealt with as part of the
partnership property; and where there is a surplus of the partnership property, it shall be dealt with as part of the
respective separate property in proportion to the rights and interests of each partner in the partnership property.
Introduction
Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 (“Code”) is a consolidated statute which deals with insolvency and
bankruptcy of corporate, limited liability partnerships (LLPs), individuals and partnership firms. Code is a one
shot solution which provides for dealing with insolvency or bankruptcy of various organizational structures
under one roof.
To prevent the abuse of this debtor-centric process the Code applies certain restrictions on the applicability and
validity of fresh start processes. This Lesson enable readers to comprehend the provisions specified under the
Code for initiating fresh start process by a debtor subject to fulfillment of certain criteria. Since the provisions of
fresh start process have not been notified under the Code therefore no statutory regulations providing the form
and manner for initiating fresh start process have been introduced yet by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board
of India (“Board”).
Qualifying Debt means amount due, which includes interest or any other sum due in respect of the amounts
owed under any contract, by the debtor for a liquidated sum either immediately or at certain future time but does
not includes
• an excluded debt;
• any debt which has been incurred three months prior to the date of the application for fresh start
process;
• liability to pay damages for negligence, nuisance or breach of a statutory, contractual or other legal
obligation;
• liability to pay maintenance to any person under any law for the time being in force;
A debtor may either personally or through a Resolution Professional may apply for fresh start process if he
fulfills the following conditions:
257
258 PP-IL&P
a) The gross annual income of the debtor does not exceed sixty thousand rupees;
b) The aggregate value of the assets of the debtor does not exceed twenty thousand rupees.
c) The aggregate value of the qualifying debts does not exceed thirty -five thousand rupees;
f) A fresh start process, insolvency resolution process or bankruptcy process is not subsisting against
him; and
g) No previous fresh start order under these provisions has been made in relation to him in the preceding
twelve months of the date of the application for fresh start.
Filing of applications for fresh start process and its effect thereof
Sub-section 4 of Section 81 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that an application filed for
fresh start process shall be in such form and manner and accompanied by such fee as may be prescribed by the
regulations after their enforcement and shall contain the following information supported by an affidavit namely:
a. List of all debts owed by the debtor as on the date of the said application along with details relating to
the amount of each debt, interest payable thereon and the names of the creditors to whom each debt
is owed;
b. The interest payable on the debts and the rate thereof stipulated in the contract;
d. The financial information of the debtor and his immediate family for up to two years prior to the date of
the application;
g. The particulars of any legal proceedings which, to the debtor’s knowledge has been commenced
against him; and
h. The confirmation that no previous fresh start order under the provisions of the Code has been made in
respect of the qualifying debts of the debtor in the preceding twelve months of the date of the application
When an application is filed under Section 80 by a debtor, an interim-moratorium shall commence on the date
of filing of said application in relation to all the debts and shall cease to have effect on the date of admission or
rejection of such application, as the case may be. During the interim-moratorium period if any legal action or
legal proceeding is pending in respect of any of debts of the debtor then same shall be deemed to have been
stayed and no creditor shall initiate any legal action or proceedings in respect of such debt.
b) Rejecting the appointment of the Resolution Professional who filed an application and nominating a
Resolution Professional suitable for the fresh start process.
Where an application under section 80 is filed by the debtor himself and not through the Resolution Professional,
the Adjudicating Authority shall direct the Board within seven days of the date of the receipt of an application
to nominate a Resolution Professional for the fresh start process. The Board shall nominate a Resolution
Professional within ten days of receiving the direction issued by the Adjudicating Authority. The Adjudicating
Authority shall by order appoint the Resolution Professional recommended or nominated by the Board.
The report by Resolution Professional shall contain the details of the amounts mentioned in the application
which in the opinion of the Resolution Professional are–
The Resolution Professional may call for such further information or explanation in connection with the application
as may be required from the debtor or any other person who, in the opinion of the Resolution Professional, may
provide such information. The debtor or any other person, as the case may be, shall furnish such information or
explanation within seven days of receipt of the request for additional information or explanation.
The Resolution Professional shall presume that the debtor is unable to pay his debts at the date of the application
if in his opinion:
a) information supplied in the application indicates that the debtor is unable to pay his debts and he has
no reason to believe that the information supplied is incorrect or incomplete; and
b) there is no change in the financial circumstances of the debtor since the date of the application enabling
the debtor to pay his debts.
The Resolution Professional shall reject the application in the following cases:
a) The debtor does not satisfy the conditions specified under Section 80; or
b) The debts disclosed in the application by the debtor are not qualifying debts; or
c) The debtor has deliberately made a false representation or omission in the application or with respect
to the documents or information submitted.
The Resolution Professional shall record the reasons for recommending the acceptance or rejection of the
application in the report to the Adjudicating Authority and shall give a copy of the report to the debtor.
qualifying debts by the Resolution Professional and other amounts eligible for discharge under Section 92 for
the purposes of the fresh start order.
A copy of the order passed by the Adjudicating Authority along with a copy of the application shall be provided
to the creditors mentioned in the application within two days of the passing of the order.
Section 85 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that on the date of admission of the application
the moratorium period shall commence in respect of all the debts of the debtor. During the moratorium period
any pending legal action or legal proceeding in respect of any debt shall be deemed to have been staye and
pursuant to the provisions of Section 86 the creditors shall not initiate any legal action or proceedings in respect
of any debt. The moratorium ceases to have effect at the end of the period of one hundred and eighty days
beginning with the date of admission unless the order admitting the application is revoked under sub-section (2)
of section 91. During the moratorium period, the debtor shall:
• not act as a director of any company, or directly or indirectly take part in or be concerned in the promotion,
formation or management of a company;
• be required to inform prior to entering into any financial or commercial transaction of such value as may
be notified by the Central Government, either individually or jointly, that he is undergoing a fresh start
process;
• disclose the name under which he enters into business transactions, if it is different from the name in
the application admitted under Section 84 and
• not travel outsides India except with the permission of the Adjudicating Authority.
b) incorrectness of the details of the qualifying debt specified in the order under Section 84.
A creditor may file an objection by way of an application to the Resolution Professional. The application shall be
supported by such information and documents as may be prescribed. The Resolution Professional shall consider
every objection made under this Section. The Resolution Professional shall examine the objections and either
accept or reject the objections within ten days of the date of the application. The Resolution Professional may
examine on any matter that appears to him to be relevant to the making of a final list of qualifying debts for the
purposes of Section 92.
a) prepare an amended list of qualifying debts for the purpose of the discharge order;
b) make an application to the Adjudicating Authority for directions under section 90; or
a) that the Resolution Professional has not given an opportunity to the debtor or the creditor to make a
representation; or
b) that the Resolution Professional colluded with the other party in arriving at the decision; or
c) that the Resolution Professional has not complied with the requirements of Section 86.
The Adjudicating Authority shall decide the application referred within fourteen days of such application and
make an order as it deems fit.Where the application has been allowed by the Adjudicating Authority it shall
forward its order to the Board and the Board may take such action as may be required against the Resolution
Professional.
a) To make available to the Resolution Professional all information relating to his affairs, attend meetings
and comply with the requests of the Resolution Professional in relation to the fresh start process.
b) To inform the Resolution Professional as soon as reasonably possible of any material error or omission
in relation to the information or document supplied to the Resolution Professional or any change in
financial circumstances after the date of application, where such change has an impact on the fresh
start process.
b) Compliance of the duties of the debtor referred to in section 88, in case on noncompliance by the
debtor.
The Resolution Professional may apply to the Adjudicating Authority for directions in relation to any other matter
under these provisions for which no specific provisions have been made.
a) if due to any change in the financial circumstances of the debtor, the debtor is ineligible for a fresh start
process; or
b) non-compliance by the debtor of the restrictions imposed under sub-section (3) of section 85; or
c) if the debtor has acted in a mala fide manner and has wilfully failed to comply with the provisions of this
Chapter.
The Adjudicating Authority shall within fourteen days of the receipt of the application may by order admit or
reject the application. On passing of the order admitting the application the moratorium and the fresh start
process shall cease to have effect. A copy of the order passed by the Adjudicating Authority under this Section
shall be provided to the Board for the purpose of recording an entry in the register referred to in section 196.
Discharge Order
Section 92 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the Resolution Professional shall prepare
a final list of qualifying debts and submit such list to the Adjudicating Authority at least seven days before the
moratorium period comes to an end. The Adjudicating Authority shall pass a discharge order at the end of the
moratorium period for discharge of the debtor from the qualifying debts.
The Adjudicating Authority shall discharge the debtor from the following liabilities namely:
a) penalties in respect of the qualifying debts from the date of application till the date of the discharge
order;
b) interest including penal interest in respect of the qualifying debts from the date of application till the date
of the discharge order; and
c) any other sums owed under any contract in respect of the qualifying debts from the date of application
till the date of the discharge order.
The discharge order shall be forwarded to the Board for the purpose of recording an entry in the register
referred to in section 196. A discharge order shall not discharge any other person apart from the debtor from
any liability in respect of the qualifying debts.
Standard of Conduct
Section 93 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016 provides that the Resolution Professional shall perform
his functions and duties in compliance with the code of conduct provided under Section 208.
Lesson 16 n Fresh Start Process 263
Application to Debt Recovery Tribunal (DRT) with the relevant information supported by
Affidavit either individually or through Resolution Professional (Interim Moratorium starts)
Admission Rejection
of of
application application
Order of DRT
Acceptance Rejection
of of
application application
Preparation of final list of qualifying debt by Resolution Professional and submission of list
to DRT atleast 7 days before moratorium period comes to an end.
An Insolvency Professional (IP) plays a very important role under the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016.
He is a significant actor in the corporate insolvency resolution process. He acts as a “Interim Resolution
Professional (IRP)” and “resolution professional (RP) ” in the corporate insolvency resolution process (specified
in Part II of the Code which deals with corporate persons) as well as a “resolution professional” under Part
III of the (which deals with Insolvency Resolution and Bankruptcy for Individuals and Partnership Firms) for
conducting the fresh start process or insolvency resolution process. As an interim resolution professional, he
performs various functions such as the collection of claims, the collection of information about the corporate
debtor, the constitution of the committee of creditors and the interim management of the company’s affairs and
monitoring of the company’s assets till a resolution professional is appointed.
An insolvency professional also acts as a liquidator in accordance with the provisions of Part II as well as a
“bankruptcy trustee” for the estate of the bankrupt under section 125 in Part III of the Code.
In the corporate insolvency resolution process, the insolvency professional runs the debtor’s business during
the moratorium period, verifies the claims of the creditors and constitutes a creditors committee and helps the
committee of creditors in arriving at a consensus for the revival and rehabilitation of the corporate debtor’s
business. In liquidation, the insolvency professional acts as a liquidator and a bankruptcy trustee. Insolvency
professionals is a class of professionals having minimum standards of professional and ethical conduct and are
regulated by “Insolvency Professional Agencies”.
Section 207(1) further lays down that every insolvency professional shall, after obtaining the membership of
any insolvency professional agency, register himself with the Board within such time, in such manner and on
payment of such fee, as may be specified by regulations. Section 207(2) empowers the IBBI to specify the
categories of professionals or persons possessing such qualifications and experience in the field of finance,
law, management, insolvency or such other field to act as insolvency professionals.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has made the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India
(Insolvency Professional) Regulations, 2016 to regulate the working of Insolvency Professionals. These
regulations are amended from time to time by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India (Insolvency Professionals) Regulations, 2016
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has made the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India
(Insolvency Professionals) Regulations, 2016 in exercise of the powers conferred by sections 196, 207 and 208
read with section 240 of the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code, 2016. These regulations came into force with
effect from 29th November 2016.
The IBBI (Insolvency Professionals) Regulations, 2016 makes provisions for the examination andregistration
of Insolvency Professionals with the Bankruptcy and Insolvency Board of India. These regulations also make
provisions for the disciplinary proceedings against the insolvency professional as well as prescribes a code of
conduct for insolvency professionals.
According to Regulation 4, no individual shall be eligible to be registered as an insolvency professional if he -
(a) is a minor;
(b) is not a person resident in India;
(c) does not have the qualification and experience specified in regulations 5 and 9 of the IBBI (Insolvency
Professionals) Regulations, 2016;
Lesson 17 n Professional and Ethical Practices for Insolvency Practitioners 267
(d) has been convicted by any competent court for an offence punishable with imprisonment for a term
exceeding six months or for an offence involving moral turpitude, and a period of five years has not
elapsed from the date of expiry of the sentence. Provided that if a person has been convicted of any
offence and sentenced in respect thereof to imprisonment for a period of seven years or more, he shall
not be eligible to be registered;
(e) he is an undischarged insolvent, or has applied to be adjudicated as an insolvent;
(f) he has been declared to be of unsound mind; or
(g) he is not a fit and proper person.
First Schedule to the aforesaid regulations prescribes a code of conduct for insolvency professionals.
According to Regulation 7(2)(h), the registration of an insolvency professional shall be subject to the condition
that he shall abide by the following Code of Conduct specified in the First Schedule to the Regulations:
9. An insolvency professional shall not influence the decision or the work of the committee of creditors or debtor,
or other stakeholders under the Code, so as to make any undue or unlawful gains for himself or his related
parties, or cause any undue preference for any other persons for undue or unlawful gains and shall not adopt
any illegal or improper means to achieve any mala fide objectives.
Professional competence
10. An insolvency professional must maintain and upgrade his professional knowledge and skills to render
competent professional service.
Representation of correct facts and correcting misapprehensions
11. An insolvency professional must inform such persons under the Code as may be required, of a misapprehension
or wrongful consideration of a fact of which he becomes aware, as soon as may be practicable.
12. An insolvency professional must not conceal any material information or knowingly make a misleading
statement to the Board, the Adjudicating Authority or any stakeholder, as applicable.
Timeliness
13. An insolvency professional must adhere to the time limits prescribed in the Code and the rules, regulations
and guidelines thereunder for insolvency resolution, liquidation or bankruptcy process, as the case may be,
and must carefully plan his actions, and promptly communicate with all stakeholders involved for the timely
discharge of his duties.
14. An insolvency professional must not act with mala fide or be negligent while performing his functions and
duties under the Code.
Information management
15. An insolvency professional must make efforts to ensure that all communication to the stakeholders, whether
in the form of notices, reports, updates, directions, or clarifications, is made well in advance and in a manner
which is simple, clear, and easily understood by the recipients.
16. An insolvency professional must ensure that he maintains written contemporaneous records for any decision
taken, the reasons for taking the decision, and the information and evidence in support of such decision. This
shall be maintained so as to sufficiently enable a reasonable person to take a view on the appropriateness of
his decisions and actions.
17. An insolvency professional must not make any private communication with any of the stakeholders unless
required by the Code, rules, regulations and guidelines thereunder, or orders of the Adjudicating Authority.
18. An insolvency professional must appear, co-operate and be available for inspections and investigations
carried out by the Board, any person authorised by the Board or the insolvency professional agency with which
he is enrolled.
19. An insolvency professional must provide all information and records as may be required by the Board or the
insolvency professional agency with which he is enrolled.
20. An insolvency professional must be available and provide information for any periodic study, research and
audit conducted by the Board.
Confidentiality
21. An insolvency professional must ensure that confidentiality of the information relating to the insolvency
resolution process, liquidation or bankruptcy process, as the case may be, is maintained at all times. However,
this shall not prevent him from disclosing any information with the consent of the relevant parties or required
by law.
Lesson 17 n Professional and Ethical Practices for Insolvency Practitioners 269
IDENTIFICATION OF THREATS
An insolvency professional should take particular care to identify the existence of threats which exist prior to or
at the time of taking an assignment or which, at that stage, it may reasonably be expected to arise during the
course of such an insolvency assignment. Each of these threats gives rise to a principle for ethical behavior and
code of conduct by the Insolvency Professional.
270 PP-IL&P
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India has made the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India
(Insolvency Resolution Process for Corporate Persons) Regulations, 2016to regulate the insolvency
resolution process for corporate persons. These regulations are amended from time to time by the Insolvency
and Bankruptcy Board of India.
Moratorium
Section 14 describes the effect of the moratorium declared under section 13 of the Code. Section 14 reads as
follows:
“(1) Subject to provisions of sub-sections (2) and (3), on the insolvency commencement date, the Adjudicating
Authority shall by order declare moratorium for prohibiting all of the following, namely:
(a) the institution of suits or continuation of pending suits or proceedings against the corporate debtor
including execution of any judgement, decree or order in any court of law, tribunal, arbitration panel or
other authority;
(b) transferring, encumbering, alienating or disposing of by the corporate debtor any of its assets or any
legal right or beneficial interest therein;
(c) any action to foreclose, recover or enforce any security interest created by the corporate debtor in
respect of its property including any action under the Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial
Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002 (54 of 2002);
(d) the recovery of any property by an owner or lessor where such property isoccupied by or in the
possession of the corporate debtor.
(2) The supply of essential goods or services to the corporate debtor as may be specified shall not be
terminated or suspended or interrupted during moratorium period.
(3) The provisions of sub-section (1) shall not apply to —
(a) such transaction as may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial
regulator;
(b) a surety in a contract of guarantee to a corporate debtor.
(4) The order of moratorium shall have effect from the date of such order till the completion of the corporate
insolvency resolution process:
Provided that where at any time during the corporate insolvency resolution process period, if the Adjudicating
Authority approves the resolution plan under sub-section (1) of section 31 or passes an order for liquidation
Lesson 17 n Professional and Ethical Practices for Insolvency Practitioners 271
of corporate debtor under section 33, the moratorium shall cease to have effect from the date of such
approval or liquidation order, as the case may be.”
Prohibition of certain acts – On the insolvency commencement date, the NCLT shall by order declare
moratorium for prohibiting all of the following acts:
(a) the institution of suits or continuation of pending suits or proceedings against the corporate
debtor including execution of any judgement, decree or order in any court of law, tribunal, arbitration
panel or other authority,
(b) transferring, encumbering, alienating or disposing of by the corporate debtor any of its assets or
any legal right or beneficial interest therein,
(c) any action to foreclose, recover or enforce any security interest created by the corporate debtor
in respect of its property including any action under the Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial
Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002,
(d) the recovery of any property by an owner or lessor where such property is occupied by or in the
possession of the corporate debtor. [Section 14(1)]
“Insolvency commencement date” means the date of admission of an application for initiating corporate
insolvency resolution process by the Adjudicating Authority under sections 7, 9 or section 10, as the case may
be. [Section 5(12)]
Section 5(12) of the Code was amended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment)
Act, 2018. The Second Amendment Act, 2018 added a proviso to section 5(12) to clarify that where the
Interim Resolution Professional (IRP) is not appointed in the order admitting application under section 7, 9
or 10, the insolvency commencement date shall be the date on which such interim resolution professional is
appointed by the Adjudicating Authority.
Supply of essential goods or services – The supply of essential goods or services to the corporate debtor
as may be specified shall not be terminated or suspended or interrupted during the moratorium period. [Section
14(2)]
Access to certain goods and services during the insolvency resolution process may be important for ensuring
orderly completion of the proceedings. However, the costs for such goods or services will have to be paid in
priority to other costs as part of a resolution plan or during distribution of assets, in case the corporate debtor
goes into liquidation.
Exclusion of certain acts – The provisions of section 14(1) shall not apply to —
(a) such transaction as may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial
regulator
(b) a surety in a contract of guarantee to a corporate debtor. [Section 14(3)]
The Central Government has been given the power to notify transactions (in consultation with the appropriate
financial sector regulators), which will be exempted from the moratorium in the interest of smooth functioning
of the financial markets.
Section 14(3) of the Code was substituted by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment)
Act, 2018to provide that the moratorium shall not apply to a surety in a contract of guarantee to a corporate
debtor.
Effect of order of moratorium – The order of moratorium shall have effect from the date of such order till the
completion of the corporate insolvency resolution process. Provided that where at any time during the corporate
insolvency resolution process period, if the NCLT approves the resolution plan under section 31(1) or passes
272 PP-IL&P
an order for liquidation of corporate debtor under section 33, the moratorium shall cease to have effect from the
date of such approval or liquidation order, as the case may be. [Section 14(4)]
Thus, the moratorium will continue to be in effect till the completion of the corporate insolvency resolution
process or the approval of a resolution plan by the adjudicating authority or the resolution of the committee of
creditors to liquidate the corporate debtor, whichever is earlier.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018amended clause (c) of sub-section
(1) of section 15 to confer power upon the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board to specify the last date for
submission of claims.
(3) Where the application for corporate insolvency resolution process is made by an operational creditor
and-
(a) no proposal for an interim resolution professional is made, the Adjudicating Authority shall make a
reference to the Board for the recommendation of an insolvency professional who may act as an interim
resolution professional;
(b) a proposal for an interim resolution professional is made under sub-section (4) of section 9, the
resolution professional as proposed, shall be appointed as the interim resolution professional, if no
disciplinary proceedings are pending against him.
(4) The Board shall, within ten days of the receipt of a reference from the Adjudicating Authority under sub-
section (3), recommend the name of an insolvency professional to the Adjudicating Authority against whom
no disciplinary proceedings are pending.
(5) The term of the interim resolution professional shall continue till the date of appointment of the resolution
professional under section 22.”
Appointment of Interim Resolution Professional – Section 16 provides that the NCLT shall appoint an
interim resolution professional within fourteen days from the insolvency commencement date. [Section 16(1)]
Section 16(2) provides that where the application for corporate insolvency resolution process is made by a
financial creditor or the corporate debtor, and the name of the resolution professional is proposed, then
such person shall be appointed as the interim resolution professional provided no disciplinary proceedings are
pending against him.
Section 16(3) provides that where the corporate insolvency resolution process is initiated on an application by
an operational creditor and the operational creditor proposes the name of interim resolution professional, the
adjudicating authority shall appoint such professional as the interim resolution professional if no disciplinary
proceedings are pending against him.
Section 16(3) further provides that if the name is not proposed by the operational creditor,then the adjudicating
authority shall make a reference to the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Board of India for recommending the name
of aperson to be appointed as the interim resolution professional.
The Board shall recommend the name of a resolution professional who meets the criteria stipulated in Clause
16(3) within ten days from the receipt of the reference. [Section 16(4)]
Tenure of Interim Resolution Professional –
Section 16(5) originally provided that the term of the interim resolution professional shall not exceed thirty days
from date of his appointment. But this sub-section was amended by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code
(Second Amendment) Act, 2018. Now the term of the interim resolution professional continues till the date of
appointment of the resolution professional under section 22 of the Code.
Duties of Interim Resolution Professional – Section 18 of the Code provides that the person appointed as
the Interim Resolution Professional shall perform the following duties:
(a) collect all information relating to the assets, finances and operations of the corporate debtor for
determining the financial position of the corporate debtor, including information relating to
(i) business operations for the previous two years,
(ii) financial and operational payments for the previous two years,
(iii) list of assets and liabilities as on the initiation date, and
(iv) such other matters as may be specified.
274 PP-IL&P
(b) receive and collate all the claims submitted by creditors to him, pursuant to the public announcement
made under sections 13 and 15,
(c) constitute a committee of creditors,
(d) monitor the assets of the corporate debtor and manage its operations until a resolution professional is
appointed by the committee of creditors,
(e) file information collected with the information utility, if necessary, and
(f) take control and custody of any asset over which the corporate debtor has ownership rights as recorded
in the balance sheet of the corporate debtor, or with information utility or the depository of securities or
any other registry that records the ownership of assets including
(i) assets over which the corporate debtor has ownership rights which may be located in a foreign
country,
(ii) assets that may or may not be in possession of the corporate debtor,
(iii) tangible assets, whether movable or immovable,
(iv) intangible assets including intellectual property,
(v) securities including shares held in any subsidiary of the corporate debtor, financial instruments,
insurance policies,
(vi) assets subject to the determination of ownership by a court or authority
(g) to perform such other duties as may be specified by the Board.
Section 18 also specifies the assets that cannot be taken over. The Explanation appended to section 18
provides that for the purposes of this section, the term “assets” shall not include the following:
(a) assets owned by a third party in possession of the corporate debtor held under trust or under
contractual arrangements including bailment;
(b) assets of any Indian or foreign subsidiary of the corporate debtor; and
(c) such other assets as may be notified by the Central Government in consultation with any financial
sector regulator.
employees of the CD. To ensure that the CD remains a going concern, all the directors/employees are required
to function and to assist the RP who manages the affairs of the CD during the moratorium. If one or other officer
or employee had the power to sign a cheque on behalf of the CD prior to the order of moratorium, such power
does not stand suspended on suspension of Board of Directors nor can it be taken away by the RP. If the person
empowered to sign cheque refuses to function on the direction of the RP or misuse the power, it is always open
to the RP to take away such power after notice to the person concerned.
Section 17(2) of the Code further provides that the interim resolution professional vested with the management
of the corporate debtor, shall
(a) act and execute in the name and on behalf of the corporate debtor all deeds, receipts, and other
documents, if any,
(b) take such actions, in the manner and subject to such restrictions, as may be specified by the Board,
(c) have the authority to access the electronic records of corporate debtor from information utility having
financial information of the corporate debtor,
(d) have the authority to access the books of accounts, records and other relevant documents of corporate
debtor available with government authorities, statutory auditors, accountants and such other persons
as may be specified and
(e) be responsible for complying with the requirements under any law for the time being in force on behalf
of the corporate debtor.
Thus, section 17 lists out the various powers that an interim resolution professional shall have, including the
power to do all acts and execute documents in the name of the corporate debtor as these powers are important
for effective discharge of his responsibilities.
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 has added clause (e) in sub-section
2 of section 17 to provide that the interim resolution professional shall be responsible for complying with the
statutory requirements under applicable laws while managing the affairs of the corporate debtor.
Section 17 has been inserted keeping in mind the experience of a debtor-in-possession regime under the
Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985. Various committee reports which had analysed
the provisions of the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 had highlighted the debtor-
in-possession regime as one of its fatal flaws. A debtor-in-possession regime which allows the existing
management to remain in possession during the resolution process gives incentives to the management to
propose and implement risky rescue measures, as the costs of failure (leading to liquidation) would largely
be borne by creditors.
The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 now stands repealed(with effect from 1st
December 2016)as the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Repeal Act, 2003 has been notified
by the Government.
“Personnel” includes the directors, managers, key managerial personnel, designated partners and employees,
if any, of the corporate debtor. [Section 5(23)]
Personnel, promoters or any other person associated with the management – The personnel of the
corporate debtor, its promoters or any other person associated with the management of the corporate debtor
shall extend all assistance and cooperation to the interim resolution professional as may be required by him in
managing the affairs of the corporate debtor. [Section 19(1)]
Application to Adjudicating Authority for necessary directions – Where any personnel of the corporate
debtor, its promoter or any other person required to assist or cooperate with the interim resolution professional
Lesson 17 n Professional and Ethical Practices for Insolvency Practitioners 277
does not assist or cooperate, the interim resolution professional may make an application to the Adjudicating
Authority for necessary directions. [Section 19(2)]
Oder by Adjudicating Authority – The Adjudicating Authority, on receiving an application under sub-section
(2), shall by an order, direct such personnel or other person to comply with the instructions of the resolution
professional and to cooperate with him in collection of information and management of the corporate debtor.
[Section 19(3)]
Interim Finance – The Interim Resolution Professional has the power to raise interim finance as well as to
enter into, amend or modify contracts on behalf of the corporate debtor. Clause (c) of sub-section (2) to section
20 provides that the Interim Resolution Professional shall have the authority to raise interim finance provided
that no security interest shall be created over any encumbered property of the corporate debtor without the
prior consent of the creditors whose debt is secured over such encumbered property. Thus, any interim finance
raised by providing security of an encumbered property of the corporate debtor will require prior permission of
the concerned creditor
The proviso appended to clause (c) of sub-section (2) to section 20 clarifies that no prior consent of the creditor
shall be required where the value of such property is not less than the amount equivalent to twice the amount
of the debt.
• “Interim finance” means any financial debt raised by the resolution professional during the insolvency
resolution process period [Section 5(15)]
• Amount of any interim finance and the costs incurred in raising such finance is included in the
“insolvency resolution process costs” [Section 5(13)]
• In case the corporate debtor goes into liquidation, the insolvency resolution process costs which
includes interim finance and the costs incurred in raising such finance are paid from the sale of the
liquidation assets in priority during the distribution of assets [Section 53]
Section 20 of the Code makes provision for raising interim finance while managing the operations of the
corporate debtor as a going concern. A company which enters the insolvency resolution proceedingsfinds it
extremely difficult to obtain credit, as lenders are often hesitant to lend to a troubled debtor. In order to address
this issue, such interim finance is treated as a part of the insolvency resolution costs and is repaid in priority to
other debt as part of resolution plan. Such priority also applies in distribution of assets in case the corporate
debtor goes into liquidation.
If the Board does not confirm the name of the proposed resolution professional within ten days of the receipt of
the name of the proposed resolution professional, the Adjudicating Authority shall, by order, direct the interim
resolution professional to continue to function as the resolution professional until such time as the Board
confirms the appointment of the proposed resolution professional.[Section 22(5)]
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018 amended section 22 of the Code
to provide for reduced voting threshold of sixty-six percent in place of seventy-five percent for obtaining the
approval of the committee of creditors for appointment of resolution professional. The Second Amendment
Act of 2018 has also amended sub-section (3) so as to require a written consent from the interim resolution
professional in specified form before his appointment.
all the information, documents and records pertaining to the corporate debtor in his possession and knowledge
to the resolution professional.
Section 23 of the Code reads as follows:
“(1) Subject to section 27, the resolution professional shall conduct the entire corporate insolvency resolution
process and manage the operations of the corporate debtor during the corporate insolvency resolution
process period:
Provided that the resolution professional shall, if the resolution plan under sub-section (6) of section 30 has
been submitted, continue to manage the operations of the corporate debtor after the expiry of the corporate
insolvency resolution process period until an order is passed by the Adjudicating Authority under section 31.]
(2) The resolution professional shall exercise powers and perform duties as are vested or conferred on the
interim resolution professional under this Chapter.
(3) In case of any appointment of a resolution professional under sub-sections (4) of section 22, the interim
resolution professional shall provide all the information, documents and records pertaining to the corporate
debtor in his possession and knowledge to the resolution professional.”
The Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second Amendment) Act, 2018amended section 23 of the Code
to provide that the resolution professional shall continue to manage the operations of the corporate debtor
after the expiry of corporate insolvency resolution process period until an order has been passed by the
Adjudicating Authority under section 31.
Clause (h) of sub-section (2) of section 25 was substituted by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code
(Amendment) Act, 2018(No 8 of 2018). Clause (h), before substitution, read as follows:
“(h) invite prospective lenders, investors, and any other persons to put forward resolution plans”.
The power under section 27 assumes significance particularly in a corporate insolvency resolution process
initiated by a corporate debtor where the corporate debtor has appointed a resolution professional of its
choice. The committee of creditors have the right to replace such resolution professional if they suspect
collusion between the resolution professional and corporate debtor/management.
Sub-section (2) of section 27 was substituted by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Second
Amendment) Act, 2018for enabling the committee of creditors to replace the existing resolution professional
with another resolution professional by a vote of sixty-six percent of voting share instead of seventy-five
percent, subject to a written consent from the latter.
Before its substitution, the sub-section (2), stood as follows:
“(2) The committee of creditors may, at a meeting, by a vote of seventy-five per cent. of voting shares, propose
to replace the resolution professional appointed under section 22 with another resolution professional.”
envisaged to be prepared in order for the resolution applicants (market participants) to provide solutions for
resolving the insolvency of the corporate debtor.
Section 29(1) provides that the resolution professional shall prepare an information memorandum in such form
and manner containing such relevant information as may be specified by the Board for formulating a resolution
plan.
Section 29(2) further provides that the resolution professional shall provide to the resolution applicant access
to all relevant information in physical and electronic form, provided such resolution applicant undertakes:
(a) to comply with provisions of law for the time being in force relating to confidentiality and insider trading,
(b) to protect any intellectual property of the corporate debtor it may have access to, and
(c) not to share relevant information with third parties unless clauses (a) and (b) of this sub-section are
complied with.
The Explanation appended to Section 29 clarifies that for the purposes of this section, “relevant information”
means the information required by the resolution applicant to make the resolution plan for the corporate debtor,
which shall include the financial position of the corporate debtor, all information related to disputes by or against
the corporate debtor and any other matter pertaining to the corporate debtor as may be specified.
“Resolution applicant” means a person, who individually or jointly with any other person, submits a resolution
plan to the resolution professional pursuant to the invitation made under clause (h) of sub-section (2) of
section 25 [Section 5(25)]
Sub-section (25) of section (5) was substituted by the Insolvency and Bankruptcy Code (Amendment)
Act, 2018(Act No 8 of 2018). Sub-section (25), before its substitution read as follows:
“(25) “resolution applicant” means any person who submits a resolution plan to the resolution professional”.